Potporni Zidovi
Potporni Zidovi
Potporni Zidovi
EM 1110-2-2502
Washington, DC 20314-1000
29 September 1989
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sept 1989
US Army Corps
of Engineers
ENGINEER MANUAL
CECW-ED
CECW-EG
Engineer Manual
No. 1110-2-2502
EM 1110-2-2502
29 September 1989
_______________
This manual supersedes EM 1110-2-2501 dated January 1948 and EM 1110-2-2502
dated 29 May 1961.
CECW-ED
CECW-EG
Engineer Manual
No. 1110-2-2502
EM 1110-2-2502
29 September 1989
Table of Contents
Subject
CHAPTER 1.
Paragraph
INTRODUCTION
Purpose
Applicability
References and Bibliography
Terms
Scope
CHAPTER 2.
Section I.
Section II.
Section III.
Section IV.
Section V.
Page
1-1
1-2
1-3
1-4
1-5
1-1
1-1
1-1
1-1
1-1
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-4
2-1
2-1
2-1
2-1
2-5
2-6
2-7
2-8
2-1
2-4
2-4
2-4
2-9
2-10
2-11
2-12
2-13
2-14
2-4
2-4
2-6
2-6
2-6
2-6
2-15
2-6
2-16
2-7
2-17
2-18
2-19
2-20
2-21
2-7
2-8
2-10
2-15
2-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Subject
Paragraph
CHAPTER 3.
FORCES ON WALLS
Section I.
Introduction
General
Limit-Equilibrium Analysis
Relationship of Forces to Sliding Analysis
Earth Pressures and Forces
Cohesionless Materials
Cohesive Materials
Pressures in Soil-Water Systems
Design Earth Pressures and Forces, Driving
Side
Design Earth Pressures and Forces, Resisting
Side
Design Earth Pressures and Forces on the
Base
At-Rest Earth Pressure Equations
Strength Mobilization Factor
Earth Force Calculation, Coulombs Equations
Earth Force Calculation, General Wedge
Method
Earth Pressure Calculations Including Wall
Friction
Distribution of Horizontal Earth Pressure
Surcharge Effects
Earth Pressures Due to Compaction
Water Pressures
Pressure Calculations
Seepage Analysis by Line-of-Creep Method
Seepage Analysis by Method of Fragments
Seepage Analysis by the Finite Element
Method
Uplift Calculations for Rock Foundations
Effect of Drains
Surge and Wave Loads
Supplemental Forces
Wind Load
Earthquake Forces
Section II.
Section III.
Section IV.
CHAPTER 4.
Section I.
Section II.
Page
3-1
3-2
3-3
3-1
3-1
3-1
3-4
3-5
3-6
3-2
3-5
3-6
3-7
3-6
3-8
3-8
3-9
3-10
3-11
3-12
3-9
3-11
3-13
3-17
3-13
3-23
3-14
3-15
3-16
3-17
3-37
3-38
3-45
3-47
3-18
3-19
3-20
3-53
3-55
3-55
3-21
3-22
3-23
3-24
3-58
3-58
3-59
3-59
3-25
3-26
3-61
3-61
4-1
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
4-5
4-1
4-1
4-1
4-2
4-6
4-7
4-3
4-3
STRUCTURE STABILITY
Scope
Loading Conditions
Representative Loading Conditions
Retaining Walls
Inland Flood Walls
Coastal Flood Walls
Stability Considerations
General Requirements
Stability Criteria
ii
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Subject
Section III.
Section IV.
Section V.
Section VI.
Paragraph
Overturning Stability
Resultant Location
Overturning Stability Criteria
Structure Sliding Stability
Overview of Sliding Stability Analysis
Sliding Factor of Safety
Assumptions and Simplifications
General Wedge Equation
Slip-Plane Angle
Single Wedge Analysis
Multiple Wedge Analysis
Sliding Stability Criteria
Design Considerations
Bearing Capacity Analysis
General Computations
Inadequate Bearing Capacity
Bearing Capacity Criteria
Summary of Design Procedures
Design Procedures
CHAPTER 5.
FOUNDATION ANALYSES
Section I.
Section II.
CHAPTER 6.
Page
4-8
4-9
4-3
4-15
4-10
4-11
4-12
4-13
4-14
4-15
4-16
4-17
4-18
4-15
4-17
4-18
4-20
4-23
4-24
4-25
4-27
4-27
4-19
4-20
4-21
4-28
4-28
4-28
4-22
4-28
5-1
5-2
5-3
5-4
5-5
5-6
5-7
5-8
5-9
5-10
5-1
5-1
5-2
5-4
5-4
5-7
5-7
5-7
5-8
5-8
5-11
5-12
5-13
5-8
5-8
5-11
6-1
6-2
6-3
6-4
6-5
6-6
6-7
6-1
6-1
6-1
6-1
6-3
6-4
6-15
iii
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Subject
Paragraph
CHAPTER 7.
Section I.
General Characteristics
Introduction
Rationale for Loading Cases
Seepage Control
General Considerations
Underseepage Control
Foundation Considerations
Base Types
Horizontal Water and Earth Loads on Keys
Unsuitable Foundation Material and Bank
Stability
Scour Protection
Types of Monoliths
Change-of-Alignment Monoliths
Closure and Abutment Monoliths
Drainage Structure Monoliths
Transition Sections Between Flood Walls and
Levees
Water Stops and Joints
Water Stops
Contraction and Expansion Joints
Site Considerations
Adjacent Structures and Rights-of-Way
Architectural and Landscaping Considerations
Instrumentation
General and Specific Considerations
Types of Instrumentation
Operation and Maintenance Manual Requirements
General Coverage
Review of Existing Flood Walls
Inspection
Repair Measures
Section II.
Section III.
Section IV.
Section V.
Section VI.
Section VII.
Section VIII.
Section IX.
CHAPTER 8.
7-1
7-2
7-1
7-1
7-3
7-4
7-3
7-3
7-5
7-6
7-10
7-10
7-7
7-8
7-10
7-13
7-9
7-10
7-11
7-13
7-13
7-13
7-12
7-13
7-13
7-14
7-17
7-17
7-15
7-16
7-21
7-22
7-17
7-18
7-22
7-23
7-19
7-24
7-20
7-21
7-24
7-26
8-1
8-2
8-3
8-4
8-1
8-1
8-1
8-1
9-1
9-2
9-3
9-4
9-1
9-1
9-1
9-1
CHAPTER 9.
Page
iv
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Subject
Load Cases
Structural
Structural
Reinforced
Foundation
Paragraph
Stability
Design
Concrete Design
Analyses
CHAPTER 10.
Section I.
Introduction
Classes of Retaining Walls
Alternate Types of Retaining Walls
Mechanically Stabilized Backfill Systems
General Background
Available Systems
Advantages and Disadvantages
Cost Considerations
Mechanisms and Behavior
Materials
Design Considerations
Construction Considerations
Instrumentation and Monitoring
Maintenance and Repair
Precast Concrete Modular Systems
Background
Basic Components
Advantages and Disadvantages
Design Considerations
Construction Considerations
Instrumentation and Monitoring
Maintenance and Repair
Section II.
Section III.
Page
9-5
9-6
9-7
9-8
9-9
9-1
9-1
9-1
9-3
9-11
10-1
10-2
10-1
10-1
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
10-8
10-9
10-10
10-11
10-12
10-1
10-1
10-2
10-7
10-7
10-9
10-10
10-12
10-13
10-13
10-13
10-14
10-15
10-16
10-17
10-18
10-19
10-14
10-14
10-14
10-14
10-19
10-20
10-20
APPENDIX A.
REFERENCES
A-1
APPENDIX B.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
B-1
APPENDIX C.
C-1
APPENDIX D.
D-1
APPENDIX E.
APPENDIX F.
E-1
F-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Subject
APPENDIX G.
APPENDIX H.
APPENDIX I.
Paragraph
Page
G-1
H-1
I-1
APPENDIX J.
J-1
APPENDIX K.
K-1
L-1
M-1
N-1
O-1
APPENDIX L.
APPENDIX M.
APPENDIX N.
APPENDIX O.
GLOSSARY
Glossary
vi
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-4
2-5
2-6
2-7
2-8
2-9
3-1
3-2
3-3
3-4
3-5
3-6
3-7
3-8
3-9
3-10
3-11
3-12
3-13
3-14
3-15
3-16
3-17
3-18
3-19
3-20
3-21
3-22
3-23
3-24
3-25
3-26
3-27
3-28
3-29
3-30
Page
Types of retaining walls
Types of flood walls
Less commonly used flood wall types
Drained friction angle versus plasticity index
SPT correction to 1 tsf (2 ksf)
versus N for granular materials
q /N versus D
c
50
Soil classification from cone penetrometer
Friction angle of granular backfills
Development of earth pressures for a cohesionless
material
Relationship of earth pressures to wall movements
Vertical and horizontal pressures in a cohesionless soil mass
Forces on base of wall
Base pressures
At-rest earth pressure coefficients
Application of the strength mobilization factor
Mohr-Coulomb failure criterion
Comparison of active earth pressures
Variables used in Coulomb equation
Comparison of passive earth pressures
Wedge method on driving side
Force polygon for wedge method on driving side
Wedge analysis for irregular backfill
Surcharge effect on critical slip plane
Wedge analysis in layered soil
Wedge method for resisting-side wedge
Passive earth pressure coefficients
Lateral pressures, one soil completely above water
table or completely below water table
Lateral pressures, one soil, water, finite surcharge
Lateral pressures, three soils, water
Pressure distribution due to irregular backfill
Lateral pressure distribution; active case, soil
with cohesion
Lateral pressure distribution; passive case, soil
with cohesion
Increase in pressure due to point load
Increase in pressure due to line load
Increase in pressure due to strip load
Resultant forces, point and line loads
Approximate line of action for line loads
Design pressure envelope for nonyielding walls
with compaction effects
vii
2-2
2-3
2-5
2-9
2-13
2-13
2-14
2-14
2-16
3-3
3-4
3-7
3-10
3-12
3-14
3-15
3-16
3-20
3-21
3-24
3-27
3-28
3-30
3-32
3-33
3-36
3-38
3-40
3-41
3-43
3-44
3-46
3-47
3-48
3-49
3-50
3-51
3-52
3-54
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
LIST OF FIGURES (Continued)
Figure
3-31
3-32
3-33
3-34
3-35
3-36
3-37
3-38
3-39
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
4-5
4-6
4-7
4-8
4-9
4-10
4-11
4-12
5-1
5-2
5-3
5-4
6-1
6-2
6-3
6-4
6-5
6-6
6-7
Page
Water pressures from flow net
Water pressure by line-of-creep method
Seepage path for line of creep
Driving and resisting seismic wedges, no saturation
Influence of k
and on magnification factor
v
Seismic wedges, water table within wedge
Static and dynamic pressure diagrams, water table
within wedge
Static and dynamic pressure diagrams, cohesive fill,
water table within wedge
Hydrodynamic forces for freestanding water
Stability considerations for retaining and flood walls
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with
horizontal base
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with a
sloping base
Relationship between base width in compression and
resultant location
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with
horizontal base and key
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with
sloping base and key
Shear force for upward sloping backfill
Typical soil/structure system with an assumed
failure surface
th
Free-body diagram of i
wedge
th
Geometry of typical i
wedge and adjacent wedges
Single wedge analysis of sliding stability
Wall design flowchart
Terms used in bearing capacity equation
Deep-seated sliding analysis with vertical face of
driving wedge at heel
Deep-seated sliding analysis with vertical face of
driving wedge at toe
Shallow shear surface
Inclined drainage blanket
Effect of drain location on excess hydrostatic pressures
on the failure plane
Drainage blanket located adjacent to retaining wall
Prefabricated drainage composite used as drain
adjacent to retaining wall
Drainage system to prevent frost penetration
behind retaining wall
Drainage system to use with clay backfill
Inspection hole for longitudinal drain
viii
3-56
3-57
3-58
3-63
3-66
3-70
3-71
3-75
3-78
4-4
4-8
4-9
4-11
4-12
4-13
4-14
4-16
4-19
4-21
4-26
4-29
5-3
5-9
5-10
5-11
6-4
6-6
6-7
6-8
6-8
6-9
6-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
LIST OF FIGURES (Continued)
Figure
6-8
6-9
6-10
7-1
7-2
7-3
7-4
7-5
7-6
7-7
7-8
7-9
7-10
7-11
9-1
9-2
9-3
9-4
9-5
10-1
10-2
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
10-8
Page
Vertical check valve at end of longitudinal drain
Approximation for estimating reduction in permeability
of narrow size-ranged aggregate caused by turbulent
flow
Summary of experience with unsatisfactory retaining
walls
Flow around interior embedded water stop in the base
T-type flood wall--horizontal base
Uplift pressures for a wall with a sheet pile cutoff
T-type flood wall--sloped base
Removal limits of unsuitable foundation material
Return keys on reentrant monolith
Flood wall-levee transitions
Typical detail of joint between I-wall and T-wall
Typical joint and water stop details
Emergency measures to control piping
Permanent water stop repair measures
Shear force for upward-sloping backfill
Rectangular beam, simple bending with no
compression reinforcement
Rectangular member, bending with small axial
compression load, no compression reinforcement
Rectangular member, bending with axial tensile load,
where M /P (d - h/2)
u u
Rectangular member, bending with axial tensile load,
where M /P < (d - h/2)
u u
Schematic diagram of reinforced earth retaining wall
Schematic diagram of reinforced soil embankment
retaining wall
VSL retained earth retaining wall
Tensar geogrid retaining wall
Schematic diagram of Doublewal retaining wall
Materials used to construct Doublewal retaining wall
Schematic diagram of Criblock retaining wall
Schematic diagram of Evergreen retaining wall
ix
6-11
6-14
6-16
7-4
7-5
7-7
7-11
7-12
7-14
7-15
7-16
7-18
7-27
7-28
9-2
9-7
9-8
9-9
9-10
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-15
10-16
10-17
10-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 1
INTRODUCTION
1-1.
Purpose.
a. General. This manual provides guidance for the safe design and economical construction of retaining and flood walls. This manual is intended
primarily for retaining walls which will be subjected to hydraulic loadings
such as flowing water, submergence, wave action, and spray, exposure to chemically contaminated atmosphere, and/or severe climatic conditions. For the design of retaining walls which will not be subjected to hydraulic loadings or
severe environmental conditions as described above, TM 5-818-1 may be used for
computing the loadings and evaluating the stability of the structure.
b. Variations from Guidance. For the evaluation of existing retaining
and flood walls which have been loaded up to or above the design loads and
show no displacement problems or any other sign of weakening, consideration
can be given to reducing the conservatism of the criteria contained in this
manual. If variations from the guidance are necessary, justification for the
variations should be submitted to HQUSACE to the attention of CECW-E for
approval.
1-2. Applicability. This manual applies to all HQUSACE/OCE elements and to
all field operating activities having responsibilities for the design of civil
works projects.
1-3. References and Bibliography. References and computer program user
guides cited in this manual are listed in Appendix A. Additional reference
materials pertaining to the subject matter addressed in this manual are
included in Appendix B, "Bibliography." Computer program abstract
descriptions are shown in Appendix O.
1-4.
Terms.
1-5.
Scope.
1-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b. Types of Foundations. This manual describes procedures for the design
of retaining and flood walls on shallow foundations, i.e., bearing directly on
rock or soil. The substructure design of pile-founded walls is not included,
but is covered in EM 1110-2-2906.
c. Flood Wall Guidance. A flood wall is treated as a special case of a
retaining wall. Unless specifically noted, the guidance herein applies to
both retaining and flood walls.
d. Geotechnical and Structural Aspects. Both geotechnical and structural
aspects of wall design are included. Coordination between geotechnical
engineers, structural engineers, and geologists in the design of retaining and
flood walls is essential.
1-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 2
GENERAL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS
Section I.
2-1. Common Types of Retaining Walls. The most common types of retaining
walls are gravity concrete, cantilever T-type reinforced concrete, and cantilever and anchored sheet pile walls. Gravity and cantilever reinforced concrete walls are covered in this manual and illustrated in Figure 2-1. Alternate types of retaining walls, including mechanically stabilized backfill and
precast modular gravity walls, are covered in Chapter 10. An example of one
type of alternate retaining wall is shown in Figure 2-1. Counterfort and
buttressed reinforced concrete walls are less commonly used and are not specifically discussed in this manual. Much of the conceptual information and
the information in Chapters 3 and 9 is applicable to all types of walls.
2-2. Gravity Concrete Wall. A gravity wall (Figure 2-1) consists of mass
concrete, generally without reinforcement. It is proportioned so that the
resultant of the forces acting on any internal plane through the wall falls
within, or close to, the kern of the section. A small tensile stress capacity
is permissible for localized stresses due to extreme and temporary loading
conditions.
2-3. Cantilever Reinforced Concrete Wall. A cantilever T-type reinforced
concrete wall (Figure 2-1) consists of a concrete stem and base slab which
form an inverted T. The structural members are fully reinforced to resist
applied moments and shears. The base is made as narrow as practicable, but
must be wide enough to ensure that the wall does not slide, overturn, settle
excessively, or exceed the bearing capacity of the foundation. The bottom of
the base should be below the zone subject to freezing and thawing or other
seasonal volume changes. The T-type wall is usually the most economical type
of conventional wall and is more widely used than any other type for common
retaining wall heights.
2-4. Alternate Types of Retaining Walls. Retaining walls using mechanically
stabilized backfill (Figure 2-1) and precast modular gravity walls can be substantially more economical to construct than conventional walls (Leary and
Klinedinst 1984). However, a short life, serious consequences of failure, or
high repair or replacement costs could offset a lower first cost. In addition, the design engineer must assure the overall adequacy of the design since
the manufacturer of the wall may provide only that part of the design above
the foundation. Chapter 10 covers mechanically stabilized backfill systems
and precast modular gravity walls.
Section II.
2-5. Common Types of Flood Walls. The most common types of flood walls are
cantilever T-type and cantilever I-type walls. Examples of these walls are
shown in Figure 2-2.
2-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
GRAVITY
ANCHORING
ELEMENTS
FACING
PANEL --+-><r~
GRANULAR
BACKFILL
2-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
R.S.
L.S.
R.S.
HORIZONTAL BASE
L.S.
SLOPED BASE
'
Figure 2-2.
2-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2-6. Cantilever T-Type Wall. Most flood walls are of the inverted T-type
(Figure 2-2). These walls are discussed in detail in Chapter 7. The cross
bar of the T serves as a base and the stem serves as the water barrier. When
founded on earth, a vertical base key is sometimes used to increase resistance
to horizontal movement. If the wall is founded on rock, a key is usually not
provided. Where required, the wall can be supported on piles. A sheet pile
cutoff can be included to control underseepage or provide scour protection for
the foundation. T-type walls may be provided with a horizontal or sloped
base. The advantages of sloped and horizontal bases are discussed in
paragraph 7-5.
2-7. Cantilever I-Type Wall. I-type flood walls consist of driven sheet
piles capped by a concrete wall (Figure 2-2). I-walls are most often used in
connection with levee and T-wall junctions or for protection in narrow restricted areas where the wall height is not over 8 to 10 feet, depending on
soil properties and geometry. The design of these types of walls is beyond
the scope of this manual.
2-8.
a. Braced Sheet Pile Flood Wall. This wall consists of a row of vertical
prestressed concrete sheet piles, backed by batter piles connected to the
sheet piles by a cast-in-place horizontal concrete beam with shear connectors
as required to resist the vertical component of load in the batter pile (Figure 2-2). This type of wall has been used for coastal flood walls. It is
ideal for wet areas because no excavation or dewatering is required to construct the wall. The disadvantage is that it is more indeterminate than other
wall types. The design of this wall is beyond the scope of this manual.
b. Less Commonly Used Types. There are various other types of walls that
may be used for flood walls such as: buttress, counterfort, gravity,
cellular, and cellular sheet pile, some of which are shown in Figure 2-3.
These walls, except for the gravity wall, are beyond the scope of this manual.
Section III.
2-9. Purpose of Walls. A retaining wall is any wall that retains material to
maintain a change in elevation whereas the principal function of a flood wall
is to prevent flooding (inundation) of adjacent land. A floodwall is subject
to water force on one side which is usually greater than any resisting earth
force on the opposite side. A wall may be a retaining wall for one loading
condition and a flood wall for another loading condition. The flood loading
(surge tide, river flood, etc.) may be from the same or the opposite direction
as the higher earth elevation.
2-10. Seepage and Leakage Control Requirements. All water-retaining structures may be subject to seepage through, under, and around them. Inadequate
control of seepage may affect the stability of a flood wall regarding uplift
or loss of support resulting from erosion. Properly controlled seepage, even
if quantities of flow remain large, presents little or no hazard. Control of
2-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
,--CELL
w.s.
w.s.
w.s.
L.S.
.CJ~
..
. .
'
'
SHEET
,II
SHEET
PILE
SHEET
PILE-~
PILE
BUTTRESS*
CELLULAR*
GRAVITY
NOTES: W.S.= WATER SIDE <OR SEAWARD. UNPROTECTED SIDE>
L.S.= LAND SIDE {OR PROTECTED SIDE>
Figure 2-3.
2-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
through-seepage is provided by water stops. Retaining walls rarely need seepage protection other than to relieve the hydrostatic load on the fill side of
the wall. Water stops are used in retaining walls to prevent water passage
from the backfill through the vertical joints. Seepage control and water
stops are more fully discussed in paragraphs 3-23, 6-4e, 6-6, 7-4, and 7-13.
2-11. Wall Stability. Generally, it is more difficult to design stable flood
walls than retaining walls. By their very nature, flood walls are usually
built in a flood plain which may have poor foundation conditions. Uplift is
always a critical item with flood walls but seldom a problem with retaining
walls since the loads acting on a retaining wall are usually soil backfills.
The water load on a flood wall can be more severe, especially when wave loadings are applicable. When the ground-water surface is near or above the wall
footing, a common occurrence with flood walls, the allowable bearing capacity
of the soil is reduced. The reduction of stability, due to the erosion of the
earth cover over and beyond the base, must be considered.
2-12. Special Flood Wall Monoliths. Careful attention must be given to wall
monoliths that have loading, support, or other conditions that vary along the
length of the monolith. These monoliths, which may include closure structures,
pipeline crossings, corner structures, etc., must be analyzed as complete
three-dimensional entities instead of the usual two-dimensional unit slices.
2-13. Design Philosophy. Retaining walls are normally built as an appurtenance to other structures: dams, hydroelectric power houses, pump stations,
etc. The consequences of failure of a retaining wall are often lower than for
flood walls. Also, retaining walls are seldom more than a few hundred feet
long; if they are designed conservatively, the added costs are of limited significance. Flood walls, on the other hand, are usually the primary feature of
a local protection project. They must be designed for the most economical
cross section per unit length of wall, because they often extend for great distances. Added to this need for an economical cross section is the requirement
for safety. The consequences of failure for a flood wall are normally very
great since it protects valuable property and human life. Thus, the design of
retaining and flood walls is a complex process involving safety and economy
factors, and design must be executed in a logical, conservative manner based
on the function of the wall and the consequences of failure. Design documents
should describe the decisions leading to the final degree of conservatism.
2-14. Stability Considerations. An adequate assessment of stability must
include a rational assessment of loads and must account for the basic structural behavior, the mechanism of transmitting compressive and shearing loads
to the foundation, the reaction of the foundation to such loads, and the
secondary effects of the foundation behavior on the structure.
Section IV.
2-15. Engineering Team. A fully coordinated team of geotechnical and structural engineers, and hydraulic engineers where applicable, should ensure that
all pertinent engineering considerations are properly integrated into the
2-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
overall design of a structure.
require coordination are:
Geotechnical Investigations
2-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
used advantageously in planning later phases. The results of each phase are
used to "characterize" the site deposits for analysis and design by developing
idealized material profiles and assigning material properties. For long,
linear structures like flood walls, geophysical methods such as seismic and
resistivity techniques often provide an ability to rapidly define general conditions during the preliminary phase at a modest cost. In alluvial floodplains, air photograph studies can often locate recent channel fillings or
other potential problem areas. A moderate number of borings should be obtained at the same time to refine the site characterization and to "calibrate"
geophysical findings. Borings should extend deep enough to sample any materials which may affect wall performance; a depth of twice the wall height
below the ground surface can be considered a conservative "rule of thumb."
For flood walls where underseepage is of concern, a sufficient number of the
borings should extend deep enough to establish the thickness of any pervious
strata.
b. Detailed Exploration. The purpose of this phase is the development of
detailed material profiles and quantification of material parameters. The
number of borings should typically be two to five times the number of preliminary borings. No exact spacing is recommended, as the boring layout
should consider geologic conditions and the characteristics of the proposed
structure. Based on the preliminary site characterization, borings should be
situated to confirm the location of significant changes in foundation conditions as well as to confirm the continuity of apparently consistent foundation
conditions. At this time, undisturbed samples should be obtained for laboratory testing and/or in situ tests should be performed.
c. Additional Exploration. In some cases, additional exploration phases
may be useful to resolve questions arising during detailed design, and/or to
provide more detailed information to bidders in the plans and specifications.
2-18.
2-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
develop when stress conditions are changed. Their behavior can be modeled for
static analyses (earth pressure, sliding, bearing) using parameters from
consolidated-drained (S) tests. Failure envelopes plotted in terms of total
or effective stresses are the same, and typically exhibit a zero c value and
a value in the range of 25 to 40 degrees. Because of the difficulty of
obtaining undisturbed samples of coarse-grained foundation materials, the
value is usually inferred from in situ tests or conservatively assumed based
on material type. Where site-specific correlations are desired for important
structures, laboratory tests may be performed on samples recompacted to simulate field density.
c.
Fine-Grained Materials.
(1) When fine-grained materials such as silts and clays are subjected to
stress changes, excess (positive or negative) pore pressures are induced
because their low permeability precludes an instantaneous water content
change. Undrained (Q or R) tests model such behavior. Shear strength envelopes for undrained tests plotted in terms of total stresses exhibit a non-zero
c parameter. However, if plotted in terms of effective stresses, the c
parameter is small (zero for all practical purposes) and the friction angle
will be essentially equal to that from a drained test. Reasonable estimates
of the drained friction angle can often be made using correlations with
the plasticity index (Figure 2-4).
Figure 2-4.
2-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2) At low stress levels, such as near the top of a wall, the undrained
strength is greater than the drained strength due to the generation of negative pore pressures which can dissipate with time. Such negative pore pressures allow steep temporary cuts to be made in clay soils. Active earth
pressures calculated using undrained parameters are minimum (sometimes negative) values that may be unconservative for design. They should be used, however, to calculate crack depths when checking the case of a water-filled
crack.
(3) At high stress levels, such as below the base of a high wall, the
undrained strength is lower than the drained strength due to generation of
positive pore pressures during shear. Consequently, bearing capacity and
sliding analyses of walls on fine-grained foundations should be checked using
both drained and undrained strengths.
(4) Certain materials such as clay shales exhibit greatly reduced shear
strength once shearing has initiated. For walls founded on such materials,
sliding analyses should include a check using residual shear strengths.
2-19.
a. Advantages. For designs involving coarse-grained foundation materials, undisturbed sampling is usually impractical and in situ testing is the
only way to obtain an estimate of material properties other than pure assumption. Even where undisturbed samples can be obtained, the use of in situ
methods to supplement conventional tests may provide several advantages:
lower costs, testing of a greater volume of material, and testing at the
in situ stress state. Although numerous types of in situ tests have been
devised, those most currently applicable to wall design are the standard penetration test, the cone penetration test, and the pressuremeter test.
b. Standard Penetration Test. The standard penetration test or SPT (ASTM
D-1586) is routinely used to estimate the relative density and friction angle
of sands using empirical correlations. To minimize effects of overburden
stress, the penetration resistance, or N value, is usually corrected to an
effective vertical overburden stress of 1 ton per square foot using an
equation of the form:
[2-1]
where
N = corrected resistance
C
= correction factor
N = measured resistance
2-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Table 2-1 and Figure 2-5 summarize the most commonly proposed values for
.
N
The drained friction angle can be estimated from N using Figure 2-6.
The relative density of normally consolidated sands can be estimated from the
correlation obtained by Marcuson and Bieganousky (1977):
where
p
vo
= coefficient of uniformity
Correlations have also been proposed between the SPT and the undrained
strength of clays. However, these are generally unreliable and should only be
used for very preliminary studies and for checking the reasonableness of SPT
and lab data.
c. Cone Penetration Test. The cone penetration test, or CPT (ASTM
D 3441-79), is widely used in Europe and is gaining considerable acceptance in
the United States. The interpretation of the test is described by Robertson
and Campanella (1983). For coarse-grained soils, the cone resistance q
has
c
been empirically correlated with standard penetration resistance (N value).
The ratio (q /N) is typically in the range of 2 to 6 and is related to median
c
grain size (see Figure 2-7). The undrained strength of fine-grained soils may
be estimated by using a modification of bearing capacity theory:
where
p
o
k
The
2-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Table 2-1
SPT Correction to 1 tsf (2 ksf)
Effective
Overburden
Stress
(kips/sq ft)
Correction Factor
__________________________
Seed,
Arango,
Peck
and Chan
and Bazaraa
(1975)
(1969)
Seed
P & B
N
Peck,
Hanson, and
Thornburn
(1974)
PH & T
0.20
2.25
2.86
0.40
1.87
2.22
1.54
0.60
1.65
1.82
1.40
0.80
1.50
1.54
1.31
1.00
1.38
1.33
1.23
1.20
1.28
1.18
1.17
1.40
1.19
1.05
1.12
1.60
1.12
0.99
1.08
1.80
1.06
0.96
1.04
2.00
1.00
0.94
1.00
2.20
0.95
0.92
0.97
2.40
0.90
0.90
0.94
2.60
0.86
0.88
0.91
2.80
0.82
0.86
0.89
3.00
0.78
0.84
0.87
3.20
0.74
0.82
0.84
3.40
0.71
0.81
0.82
3.60
0.68
0.79
0.81
3.80
0.65
0.78
0.79
4.00
0.62
0.76
0.77
4.20
0.60
0.75
0.75
4.40
0.57
0.73
0.74
4.60
0.55
0.72
0.72
4.80
0.52
0.71
0.71
5.00
0.50
0.70
0.70
2-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 2-6.
versus
2-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 2-7.
Figure 2-8.
q /N versus D
(after
c
50
Robertson and Campanella 1983)
2-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d. Pressuremeter Test. The pressuremeter test, or PMT, also originated
in Europe. Its use and interpretation are discussed by Baguelin, Jezequel,
and Shields (1978). Test results are normally used to directly calculate
bearing capacity and settlements, but the test can be used to estimate
strength parameters. The undrained strength of fine-grained materials is
given by:
[2-4]
where
p
= limit pressure
2-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
45"
!/}
(])
Q)
C1l
Q)
40
c
-&
w
_J
<..?
:z
35"
z
2-16
t-
0::
l.L
30
SM
SP
sw
GM
GP
MATERIAL CLASSIFICATION
Figure 2-9.
GW
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 3
FORCES ON WALLS
Section I.
Introduction
3-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Section II.
3-4.
Cohesionless Materials.
3-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.00 Ih - 0.003h
-~11I
+T
I
I
I
I
I
I
oo=
at-rest pressure
00 = active pressure
a.
0.02h - 0.2h
11----.\
\
~--o;
\
\
\
\
+T
ao=
at-rest pressure
op= passive pressure
b.
Figure 3-1.
3-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
10
8
6
5
4
3
a::
::>
(./')
(/')
0.::
(L
:::c
1a::
<:1(
w
w
TERZAGHI
l/)
<(
CL
u..
0.8
0.6
0.5
0.8
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.3
u
u..
u..
0.2
w
u
0
(./')
0:::
a..
I
1-
a::
<:1(
w
w
PRINCETON
TESTS
OA
1-
::J
(/')
LOOSE SAND
Q.
I/)
0.::
>:::.t:::
10
8
6
5
4
3
>
1-
<:1(
1...!...
1-
0.2
0.1
0.06
LJ...
u..
w
0
u
0.1
0.04
WALL ROTATION
0.02
0.004
WALL ROTATION
y
h
rl
h
PASSIVE CASE
Figure 3-2.
ACTIVE CASE
3-4
<[
~
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
3-5.
Cohesive Materials.
a. Strength Properties. So-called cohesive materials, typically finegrained soils such as clay, exhibit shear strength under zero confining stress
when loaded rapidly. The strength at zero confinement is expressed by the
parameter c , or cohesion. Cohesive materials are usually saturated or
nearly saturated because their small pore diameter attracts capillary water.
When stress changes are imposed (such as by wall movement) the soil attempts
to change volume. If low permeability prevents volume change from keeping
pace with the external stress change, pressure changes are induced in the pore
water. What appears to be stress-independent strength (cohesion) is, for the
most part, the combined effects of frictional resistance between soil particles and induced pore pressure changes. Pore water tension at low stresses
permits vertical cuts in clay; however, such cuts eventually fail as negative
pore pressures dissipate and water content increases. Horizontal pressures in
cohesive materials are related to the soils permeability and pore pressure
response during shear in addition to wall movement. Therefore they are time
dependent.
b. Use as a Backfill Material. It is strongly recommended that cohesionless materials such as clean sands be used for wall backfill materials.
Cohesionless materials have more predictable properties than cohesive materials, are less frost susceptible, and provide better drainage. However,
there are certain instances (such as walls adjacent to impervious clay cutoffs
in flood-control structures) where clay backfills may be unavoidable.
c. Short- and Long-Term Analyses. Solutions are included herein for
earth pressures in the terms of the general case involving both the c and
parameters. Where cohesive backfills are used, two analyses (short-term and
long-term) are usually required with different sets of strength parameters in
order to model conditions that may arise during the life of the wall.
Strength tests are further discussed in Chapter 2, Section V.
(1) Short-Term Analyses. These analyses model conditions prevailing
before pore pressure dissipation occurs, such as the end-of-construction condition. For these analyses, unconsolidated-undrained (Q) test parameters are
appropriate. Often these tests yield a relatively high c value and a low or
zero value. Calculations may indicate that the soil is in tension to significant depths and exerts zero pressure on the wall; thus, the short-term
analysis alone will seldom govern wall design. However, the zone of theoretically negative soil pressure may correspond to cracking and should be assumed
to crack as described in paragraphs 3-15f and 4-18. Water entering these
cracks may exert significant horizontal pressure on a wall. Therefore, shortterm stability analyses should include a check of the effect of water pressure
in tension cracks.
(2) Long-Term Analyses.
These analyses model conditions prevailing
after shear-induced excess pore pressures have dissipated.
(Dissipation
herein includes negative pore pressures increasing to zero.) For long-term
analysis, consolidated-drained (S) test parameters are appropriate. These
3-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
tests usually yield a relatively high
c value.
3-6
SOIL I
.
.Y1 moist
,
'
Y1
or
. . . ..
'
3-7
'
1<2
KI
a:'V
..
'
">'; sat
:sz
SOIL 2
-a:'=
H
sat,
I( I
~moist or
crH =o;; + u
cr;H = K o:'V
.
Y2 sot
.
.
porewoter
pressure,u
effect! e
horizon al
stress, o-H
..
SOIL 3
Y3 sat
K:s
Figure 3-3.
total vertical
stress, O"v
total horizontal
stress, (]' H
porewoter
pressure, u
a:v
VERTICAL PRESSURE
a:'H
HORIZONTAL PRESSURE
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
effective
vertical
stress, o-~
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
are in the at-rest pressure range when a safety factor of 1.5 is obtained.
c. Compaction and Surcharge Effects. Where significant compaction effort
is specified for the backfill, design earth pressures should be increased
beyond the at-rest values for depths above a "critical" depth as described in
paragraph 3-17. Where surcharges are expected above the backfill (in stockpiles, rails, footings, etc.), the additional horizontal earth pressure due to
the surcharge should be determined as discussed in paragraph 3-16 and superimposed on the at-rest pressure diagram. Examples of these effects are given
in Appendix M.
3-8.
3-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2) Assume that the resisting-side earth force equals zero or calculate
and apply the at-rest earth force on the resisting side of the wall, if justified (paragraphs 3-10 through 3-13). Add water forces if present.
(3) Assume that the horizontal component of the base resultant is equal
to the difference between the horizontal forces from (1) and (2).
(4) If the maximum available base shear force is exceeded, assume that
the remaining horizontal force is resisted by mobilizing a greater fraction of
passive pressure so long as not more than one-half the available passive force
is used. (This may occur where the resisting-side soil is strong relative to
the driving-side and base soils.)
d. Sliding Stability Check. Sliding stability should be checked using
the single or multiple wedge methods found in paragraphs 4-15 and 4-16,
respectively.
3-9.
where
N = effective normal force on base of structure
B = width of base of structure
e = eccentricity of
3-9
wedge
wed e
'IJA\\WA\\\
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Structural
Structural
I
I
I
I
I
I
Po~
I
I
r,
We
[~
Ws2
~Ws2
I
o.....;;...
3-10
.,.___ ~
1.......--=--............J~-
PR
.........
(){
~-------
b.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
This is shown in Figure 3-5, a and b. If the resultant falls outside the
middle one-third of the base, i.e., e is greater than B/6 , as shown in
Figure 3-5c, the pressure distribution is triangular with a maximum pressure
equal to
where
= drained internal friction angle
= effective unit weight (moist or saturated above water table,
submerged or buoyant below water table)
z = depth below surface of backfill along a vertical plane
b. Sloping Backfills. For normally consolidated sloping backfills,
results of experiments to measure K
are quite variable. The following
o
equation proposed by the Danish Code (Danish Geotechnical Institute 1978) is
recommended:
[3-5]
3-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
B
N'
Me
-A+
- -II
9;mox =
(~)C
~mm (~)(I
6:)
- 6~)
'
9;mln
I
, e
a.
N' 9,mox
~min= 0
N'
, e
'b
B
b.
c.
Base pressures
3-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Substituting Equation 3-4 in 3-5 gives:
where is the slope angle from the horizontal. is positive for a soil
layer that slopes upward and away from the structure. Values for K
and
o
K
are given in Appendix E.
o
c. General Conditions. For walls with irregular backfill surfaces, nonhomogeneous backfills, surcharge loadings, and/or other complicating conditions, empirical relationships for the at-rest pressure are not generally
available. For routine designs, an approximate solution for the horizontal
earth force may be obtained using Coulombs active force equation or the general wedge method with values of c and tan multiplied by a strength
mobilization factor (defined in paragraph 3-11). Because this is an empirical
approach, results will differ slightly from calculations using Equations 3-4
through 3-6 where companion solutions can be obtained. Appendix E includes a
comparison of K
values so obtained for both horizontal and sloping backo
fills. Figure 3-6 shows a comparison of Jakys equation with Coulombs equation for a horizontal backfill.
d.
used to
sloping
example
3-11.
Resisting Side. Jakys equation and the Danish Code equation may be
compute at-rest pressures for the resisting side for horizontal and
soil surfaces, respectively. Example computations are shown in
7 of Appendix M and in Appendix N.
Strength Mobilization Factor.
3-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-6.
3-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~
N'
'1> f<c,>
!
N'
1::> f (C0 , 0 )
11,, <!?, =f ( SMF )
!
p
AssuMe SMF
Solve for
= 2/3
Solve for
------.,..------,----r----1
3-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-8.
where
= effective normal stress
n
,c = shear strength parameters of soil (where and c in the above
equation are drained strengths ( = , c = c) for long-term
analysis and undrained ( = 0, c = S ) for short-term analysis of
u
cohesive materials).
The failure plane is inclined 45 + /2 degrees from the plane of the major
principal stress.
For limit-equilibrium analyses to be valid, the assumed
slip surface must be inclined at this angle relative to the principal
stresses. In the Coulomb and general wedge methods, a plane slip surface is
assumed. Discontinuities in the backfill surface, surcharges, and wall friction all cause variation in the principal stress directions and induce
3-16
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
curvature in the slip surface. Assuming that the plane slip surface approximation is valid and is properly oriented relative to the principal stresses,
the shear stress on it is:
To estimate at-rest pressures for design using Coulombs active earth pressure
equation or the general wedge equation, the SMF should be taken as 2/3
(0.667). K
values so obtained are compared with Jakys equation in Figo
ure 3-6. The Coulomb equation with an SMF of 2/3 is compared to the Danish
Code and Jaky equations in Appendix E. It should be noted that as the ratio,
tan /tan , exceeds 0.56, the lateral earth force computed by the Coulomb or
general wedge equations using an SMF = 2/3 will be increasingly larger than
that given by computing the earth force using a K
given by the Danish Code
o
equation, for those conditions where the Danish Code equation applies. Therefore, computing at-rest earth loadings using the Coulomb or general wedge
equations for a sloping backfill when tan /tan exceeds 0.56 will be conservative (see Appendix E).
3-12.
a.
(1) Coulombs equations solve for active and passive earth forces by
analyzing the equilibrium of a wedge-shaped soil mass. The mass is assumed to
be a rigid body sliding along a plane slip surface. Design (at-rest) earth
pressures and forces may be estimated using developed shear strength parameters (Equation 3-10) corresponding to an SMF of 2/3 in the Coulomb active
earth force equation. The Coulomb equations have the advantage of providing a
direct solution where the following conditions hold:
3-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(a) There is only one soil material (material properties are constant).
There can be more than one soil layer if all the soil layers are horizontal.
(b)
(c) The backfill is completely above or completely below the water table,
unless the top surface is horizontal, in which case the water table may be
anywhere within the backfill.
(d)
wedge.
Any surcharge is uniform and covers the entire surface of the driving
(1)
In the above
3-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
(4) For the special case of no wall friction, horizontal backfill surface, and a vertical wall, Coulombs equation for K
reduces to:
A
3-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
20
_J
35
15
<(
0:::
0...
())
<...:)
>
10
1<(
RANKINE
>
cp= 20
:::2:
w
IJ)
0
0:::
_J
0:::
LL
(.)
a=
10 -zoe
w
0:::
w
LL
LL
Cl
-5
<...:)
<(
t--
>
1-
0:::
>
c::
0...
<(
-10
COULOMB
ct>= 40 a= 1oc -30
1/)
(.)
I
RANKINE
-15
z
0
z
ct> = 4o ...
a=
-20
NOTE:
Figure 3-9.
3-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-10.
3-21
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(6) For the horizontal component of the earth force acting on a vertical
plane, with no wall friction, the term (1/sin cos ) in Coulombs equation
is equal to unity. Thus, Equation 3-11 reduces to
(7) If total stress or undrained strength parameters are used and there
is a cohesion term c it has the effect of reducing the active earth force
P
:
AH
equals
K .
A
force due to the effect of cohesion on the slip plane and the third term accounts for the shortened length of slip plane due to the effect of a tension
crack. If the third term is neglected, and K is assumed constant with
depth, the active pressure can be obtained as the derivative of P
with
AH
respect to the depth from the top of the wall z :
3-22
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
(1) The Coulomb and general wedge equations assume a plane slip surface.
However, wall friction effects cause the actual slip surface at failure to be
curved. For active pressure calculations, the magnitude of error introduced
by the plane surface assumption is not significant, as shown in Figure 3-9
(Driscoll 1979). Coulombs passive force equation, however, is grossly unconservative where wall friction is present as shown in Figure 3-11 (Driscoll
1979). However, where is less than about one-third , the error is
small. If wall friction is neglected, Coulombs equation is therefore acceptable. The Coulomb passive pressure coefficient for the case of no wall friction ( = 0) and a vertical wall ( = 90 degrees) is:
(2) If total stress or undrained strength parameters are used and there
is a cohesion term c , it has the effect of increasing the passive earth
force p
:
PH
By differentiating
resisting wedge
3-13.
3-23
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
300
_..J
<(
0::::
0....
(./)
200
(.?
0
_..J
0::::
LL
w
>
-
I-
u
z
<
>
0.::
w
1/)
z
0::::
LL
LL
z
0
z
w
w
w
0"
100
(.?
<(
I-
0:::
35
40
0....
w
>
1-
<
>
RANKINE
= 40 ' ~ =
0.::
w
z
0
u
1/)
-100
NOTE:
Figure 3-11.
JOO -400
3-24
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
termed wedges. The horizontal earth force on the driving or resisting side of
a retaining structure may be estimated by such an analysis employing properly
chosen strength parameters. Where the special conditions listed in paragraph 3-12a(1) apply, the weight of the sliding mass and orientation of the
critical sliding plane are unique functions of the backfill geometry and soil
properties, and Coulombs equations provide direct solutions for the driving
and resisting earth forces. Where one or more of the variables in Coulombs
equation cannot be accommodated as a single value (such as the case with multiple soils where not all of the soil layers are horizontal, location of the
water table, irregular backfills or where nonuniform surcharges are present),
the critical inclination of the sliding surface and, in turn, the gravity
forces (weight plus surcharges) on the sliding mass must be solved in order to
calculate the horizontal earth force. In these cases, this requires a trial
and error solution using the general wedge equation.
b. Use in Practice. When used with unfactored soil strength parameters,
the general wedge equations yield the active and passive earth forces. When
c and tan are factored by an SMF value of 2/3, solution of the drivingside wedge provides an estimate of the at-rest earth forces (see paragraph 3-12). An SMF of 2/3 is not used to compute the resisting wedge force
for the overturning, bearing, and structural design of the wall since a larger
resisting force than is acceptable would be computed. See paragraph 3-8 for
the procedure recommended to determine the resisting force for overturning and
bearing capacity analyses and structural design of the wall.
c.
3-25
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
P
EE
= any external horizontal force applied to the wedge from the left,
acting to the right
= any external horizontal force applied to the wedge from the right,
acting to the left
= internal water force acting on the side of the wedge free body (P
W
is equal to the net difference of the water force for wedge seg
ments with water on two vertical sides as shown in Figures 3-12
and 3-13.)
tan
and c
are as defined in parad
d
graph 3-11. Equation 3-23 is derived for failure occurring from left to
right. All values are positive in the directions indicated in Figure 3-12.
Refer to Appendix M for examples using Equation 3-23.
(2)
(b) For the special case of a backfill with a planar (flat or inclined)
top surface and a strip surcharge V , the following equation can be used to
compute the critical value:
3-26
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a.
PW[--~"'1
.__--n:----
b.
{-/tan
\
c.
Figure 3-12.
N'
Derivation of force F
Wedge method on driving side
3-27
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-13.
The above equation for assumes that the backfill is completely above or
completely below the water table, but can be used when the water table is anywhere within the backfill with sufficient accuracy for design. The surcharge
V can have any arbitrary shape but must be contained entirely within the
driving wedge. The equations for c
and c
are:
1
2
(i)
3-28
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(ii)
where
These equations when applied to a cohesive backfill are subject to the limitations described in paragraph 3-12b(8). The derivation of these equations is
shown in Appendix G. Examples using these equations are shown in Appendix M.
3-29
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2h
- --
f3 avg = /3
' , /3 =/3max
' '
--
.......
at x
= 2h
h = Wall height
'
/3=/3a~g--
---
f3 = /3min=O
2h
{3 avg = {3
max -
{3 min
2
f3max calculated at
X = 2h
f3 = f3min
/3
Figure 3-14.
3-30
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
surcharge is determined by setting the denominator of the equation for
c
equal to zero and solving for V . This value is:
2
or
V V
Even when
V < V
3-31
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-15.
3-32
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(XI
etCuu
SOIL 2
SOIL 3
SOIL 4
a.
Wedge 1
a = f ( Pmax)
Found by trial
SOIL
SOIL 2
SOIL 3
..---'
SOIL 4
~----
b.
Figure 3-16.
-~
Wedge 2
3-33
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
If the surfaces of all layers are horizontal, the critical slip plane may be
determined using Equation 3-24.
(5) Surcharges. The wedge method incorporates surcharge effects into the
resultant earth force if the surcharge force is added to the wedge weight.
However, it is preferable to calculate horizontal pressures due to surcharges
separately for the following reasons:
(a) The presence of a nonuniform surcharge alters the principal stress
directions, increasing the curvature of the slip surface, and increasing the
error associated with assuming a plane surface.
(b) Stresses induced by surcharges are distributed throughout a
in a manner that may considerably alter the point of application and
tribution of earth pressure as further described in paragraph 3-16.
equilibrium techniques and the earth pressure coefficient concept do
accurately predict such distributions.
soil mass
disLimitnot
(c) The additional pressures developed on the wall depend on the amount
of wall movement and may be twice as great for nonyielding walls as for
yielding walls.
The intent of this manual is to consider walls to be relatively rigid and to
design for at-rest conditions. Therefore, pressures and forces due to nonuniform surcharges should be calculated in accordance with paragraph 3-16,
adding the results to the pressures and/or forces obtained from Coulombs
equation or the general wedge equation. For the sliding analysis, surcharge
effects may be included directly in the wedge method weight calculations
because the sliding analysis considers only force equilibrium; thus, the point
of application of the forces does not matter. Examples 4 and 10 of Appendix M
demonstrate the calculation of horizontal pressures involving surcharges.
(6)
Pressure Coefficients.
(a) Structural engineers are familiar with the use of Coulombs equations
(paragraph 3-12) for the determination of earth pressure coefficients and the
use of these coefficients in determining pressures and forces acting on
retaining walls. These equations suffer from several limitations as discussed
in paragraph 3-12a(1). The general wedge equation (Equation 3-23) is not
subject to any of the limitations of Coulombs equations and may be used to
solve for the lateral earth force on a wedge due to complicated geometry and
surface loading. If lateral earth pressure coefficients are derived from the
general wedge equation, these coefficients may be used in a rather simple
manner to solve complex earth pressure problems.
(b) Earth pressures can be calculated from general wedge method solutions
by assuming that pressures vary in a piecewise linear fashion and that the
slopes of the pressure diagrams are the product of densities and pressure
coefficients (K). The slopes may be considered the density of an "equivalent
fluid" loading the wall. These pressure coefficients are dependent on the
3-34
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
problem geometry and are derived in Appendix H. It should be noted that pressure coefficients (K values) below the water table may differ from those
above the water table in the same material as shown in Appendix H. One example where the K value is different above and below the water table is the
case of a sloping backfill. Examples using pressure coefficients are shown in
Appendix M.
d.
where the terms are the same as for the driving-side wedge equation (Equation 3-23). Equation 3-33 is derived for failure occurring from left to
right. All values are positive in the directions indicated in Figure 3-17.
(2)
can be
(b) The critical angle for a resisting-side wedge with a planar (flat
or inclined) top surface, with no surcharge or with a strip surcharge V , is
given by the equation:
3-35
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
----1
I
f3\
,...... ......
I
I
\;;!.)
...._
....... ...._
.......
,'@ :@,.-"
..
a.
I .-"
~--PwR
r--r---m~----~~
cL
b.
c.
Figure 3-17.
3-36
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
For a resisting-side wedge, the equations for
and c
are
3-37
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-18.
3-15.
The wall will not move or it will rotate about the base.
3-38
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2) The water table is at or below the base of the wall or at or above
the top of the wall (submerged soil).
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
where
K = K
where
z
3-39
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-19.
3-40
v
. '\;7
Y., K
Zw
3-41
z
y~
"
P
Figure 3-20
H soli
+
P water
PH
surcharge
PH
TOTAL
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d. Layered Soils. Where layered soils are present, the pressure diagram
is a triangle underlain by a series of trapezoids given by:
where
K
th
= horizontal earth pressure coefficient for the i
layer
th
p = vertical effective earth pressure at the top of the i
layer
vi
th
= effective unit weight of the i
layer
i
th
z = vertical distance measured down from the top of the i
layer
i
An example is shown in Figure 3-21.
e. Irregular Backfills. Where the backfill is irregular, the pressure
diagram may be estimated by performing successive wedge analyses at incremental depths from the top of the wall and applying the force difference from
successive analyses over the corresponding vertical area increment
(Agostinelli et al. 1981). Since this procedure is approximate, increasing
the number of calculation points does not necessarily increase accuracy. An
example of this procedure is shown in Figure 3-22. The pressure diagram may
also be estimated by the use of pressure coefficients (see paragraphs 3-13c(6)) as shown in examples 7, 8, and 9 of Appendix M.
f.
Cohesion Effects.
(1) Where the backfill is horizontal and where cohesion is present, its
theoretical effect is to reduce the driving side earth pressure by 2c K
d A
for the entire depth of the soil layer (see Equation 3-18). This infers
tension in the soil to a "crack depth" d
where
c
Consequently there is zero load on the wall in this region. For sloping backfills, see Appendixes H and I. Where cohesion is present, a water-filled tension crack should be considered in the inferred tension zone. The maximum
crack depth using the unfactored c value should also be checked. Where the
horizontal earth force is calculated from a pressure diagram that includes
negative pressure, the force reduction due to the inferred negative pressure
zone should be taken as zero. The pressure on the driving side should be
3-42
'
'lb/ft
y; K,
II
-z
3-43
Y2, K2
"\7,
~.
Yz , K2
x
PH
water
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-21.
soil+ surcharge
\.
\.
'\
\.
'\
\.
'\
'\
'\
'\
'\
\.
\.
\.
'\
\.
'\
\.
''
'\
'\
''
'
' ''
'
'
Calculate force
from wedge
'
analysis
''
'\
\.
\.
\.
\.
'\
\.
\.
'\
'\
'\ (2 ~
'' '
' ' r3'
''
'\
\..'-...1
'\
'\
'\
\.
3-44
'
...... .I
\....... .I
p3
--
I
I
p4
I
I
z
z
rs)
5 I
I
~ctuol
pressure
distribution
P2 . e t c ....
Figure 3-22.
-e
PI = p2 - PI
P2 ::: R3 -
\.
\_..
II
p2
\.
'\
\. ....... .I
\.
'\
''
'\
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
\.
\.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
computed using Equation 3-18 by setting the 2nd term equal to 0 and K
A
to K
and using the pressure distribution as shown in Figure 3-23.
o
equal
(2) For the resisting side, passive pressure theory indicates no tension
crack will form and the pressure would be calculated using Equation 3-22. The
pressure distribution for a cohesive soil on the resisting side of a structure
is shown in Figure 3-24. However, for operating conditions without movement,
a tension crack may form due to moisture loss reducing or eliminating the resisting side pressure. See paragraph 3-8 for resisting pressure to be used
for design.
(3)
g.
(1) Where the expected mode of wall movement is translation and/or rotation about a point other than the base (such as for braced walls) the value of
K varies with depth and the horizontal earth pressure distribution will be
parabolic rather than triangular. Solution methods for such conditions are
less reliable than those for rotation about the base. Available methods include Rendulics procedure (Winterkorn and Fang 1975), Dubrovas procedure
(Harr 1977), and a procedure given by Wu (1966).
(2) Where the expected mode of wall movement is translation and/or
rotation about a point other than the base, the force may be assumed the same
as that obtained for rotation about the base, but the point of application
should be taken at 45 percent of the wall height above the base.
3-16.
Surcharge Effects.
Finite Surcharges.
3-45
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-zc
Water-filled
crack
2c
yfl<:
3-46
Neglect
tension
4'
P
Figure 3-23.
H soil
Pwater
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-24.
3-47
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Point Load
z= bh
h
SECTION
(below)
PLAN
J(
.6.PHz=
~ ~~v)(
(0.16 + b 2 ) 3
f or a
<
o4
.
{)( = tan- 1 (
Xh)
Figure 3-25.
3-48
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Line Load
z= bh
h
for a
)(
Figure 3-26.
0.203 b )
(0.16 + b 2
2)
> 0.4
for a
< 0.4
3-49
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
!
I
6 PHZ=
7T ~ ( f3 -
sin
f3 cos 2 ex )
-%- ( f3 -
sin
f3 cos2 ex)
7T
f3 in r-adians
ex = ton
-1(X2
X1)
2z
Figure 3-27.
3-50
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Point Load,V
a
ll PH
0.4
0.5
0.6
0. 78 <V /h)
0.60 <V /h)
0.46 (V/h)
.59 h
a54 h
.48 h
Line Load9V/ft
for a ~ 0.4
~PH
= 0.55 v
> 0.4
~pH
= 0.64 v
for a
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.1
Figure 3-28.
(a2 + I )
y
0.60
0.56
0.52
0.48
h
h
h
3-51
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
v
II bd
b'c' II be
a'c'
a'b' + - - - -
/
/
be is failure surface
without surcharge
(ex' from horizontal)
v
7
_..,..
,/Cp /
,
/ ,
a'b
'
-~-
//' /r,/
, /
~ :,_-
.Y
a'c'
,~u
II bd
..... --.
......
,
,,_,--b
Figure 3-29.
be is failure surface
without surcharge
am is critical slip
angle with surcharge
if am= ex' .6P= 0
3-52
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
for walls designed for at-rest conditions. The roller is assumed to exert a
line load of P lb/ft obtained from the roller weight and drum dimensions;
double this value is recommended for vibratory rollers. The design pressure
diagram (Figure 3-30) is composed of three linear segments:
a. Starting at the top of the wall, the pressure increases linearly to a
value of p
at a depth z
. In this region, the horizontal stress is
hm
cr
increased during compaction due to the roller pressure but then the horizontal
stress is reduced by passive failure when the roller is removed.
b. The horizontal pressure is constant with depth from
is compaction induced.
c.
At depth
z
cr
to
and
Water Pressures
3-53
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Earth Pressure
~
Zcr
.............
........
........
........
z2
........
........
........
........
...........
\
\
p'hm
~-- ........
........
2'KoPY'
=V
KA 7T
\
\
Depth from
top of fill
= Ko y'z
hm
3-54
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
the vertical sides of the wedge. Consequently, it gives the effective earth
force, and water forces must be added to obtain total forces (see example 3 in
Appendix M).
d. Water Pressures Where Seepage is Present. Where seepage occurs, the
pressure head at points of interest must be obtained from a seepage analysis.
Such an analysis must consider the types of foundation and backfill materials,
their possible range of horizontal and vertical permeabilities, and the effectiveness of drains. Techniques of seepage analysis are discussed in EM 11102-1901, Casagrande (1937), Cedergren (1967), Harr (1962), and other references. Techniques applicable to wall design include flow nets and numerical
methods such as the finite element method and the method of fragments. An
example of pressure calculations using a flow net is shown in Figure 3-31.
Where soil conditions adjacent to and below a wall can be assumed homogeneous
(or can be mathematically transformed into equivalent homogeneous conditions)
simplified methods such as the line-of-creep method may be used. Simplified
methods are advantageous for preliminary studies to size wall elements or compare alternate wall designs; however, designers should ensure that the final
design incorporates water pressures based on appropriate consideration of
actual soil conditions.
3-19. Seepage Analysis by Line-of-Creep Method. Where soil conditions can be
assumed homogeneous, the line-of-creep (or line-of-seepage) method provides a
reasonable approximate method for estimating uplift pressures that is particularly useful for preliminary or comparative designs. The line of creep may
underestimate uplift pressures on the base and thus be unconservative. Therefore, final design should be based on a more rigorous analysis. The method is
illustrated in Figure 3-32. The total heads at the ends of the base (points B
and C) are estimated by assuming that the total head varies linearly along the
shortest possible seepage path (ABCD). Once the total head at B and C is
known, the uplift pressures U
and U
are calculated by subtracting the
B
C
elevation head from the total head at each point and multiplying the resulting
pressure head by the unit weight of water. The total uplift diagram along the
failure surface is completed in a similar manner. Where a key is present
(Figure 3-33), point B is at the bottom of the key and line segment BC is
drawn diagonally. Examples using the line-of-creep method are contained in
Appendix N.
3-20. Seepage Analysis by Method of Fragments. Another approximate method
applicable to homogeneous soil conditions is the method of fragments. It is
more accurate than the line-of-creep method. The soil is divided into a
number of regions or fragments for which exact solutions of the seepage conditions exist. The head loss through each fragment is calculated by mathematically combining the assemblage of fragments. The method assumes that
fragment boundaries are equipotential lines (contours of equal total head) and
provides an exact solution where this assumption is true (I-walls and single
sheet piles). Details of the method and instructions for the computer program
CFRAG (Appendix O) are presented by Pace, et al. (1984). Further background
on the method is presented by Harr (1962, 1977). Keyed bases should be
modeled by treating the key as a sheet pile and the soil below the base as a
3-55
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Headwater Side
/1/HI/~
Tailwater Side
111M~
EL510
A\
"'
\
\
EL507
\
EL.504
'/ 0
c.
EL.501
DATUM
EL 0.0
Impervious
Pt. A
Total Head:
Elevation Head:
Pressure Head~
Pressure~
Pt. B
Totol Head:
Elevation Head:
Pressure Head:
Pressure:
Figure 3-31.
510
510
0
0
501
509 - 50 I = 8'
( 8 )( 62.4 )
= 499.2
lb/ft 2
3-56
)=
509
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Headwater Side
Tailwater Side
EL.51 0
A, ..
. . \
EL.507
\.
\
\
EL.504
\
\
./ D .
0'1
\
\
/.
I
I
\~!--Ao-.----....---1
I /
EL.50 I
EL.=
Datum 6l 0.0
(8
Total Head at 8:
>
510 ft.
510 ft.
0 ft.
510-
Elevation Head at 8:
Pressure Head at B =
(c )
Total Head at C:
510 -
Figure 3-32.
Pw
>]<510- 507
~ A'BCD'Jj
>
50 I
Total Head - Elevation Head
Elevation Head at C:
Water Pressure:
[<A'8
[< A'BC
Jl
~ A'BCD'lJ
( 510 - 507 )
501
etc.
= 'Yw . ( Pressure
Head )
3-57
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-33.
3-58
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
founded on competent rock typically occurs in joints and fractures, not uniformly through pores as assumed for soils. Consequently, the assumptions of
isotropy and homogeneity and the use of two-dimensional analysis models commonly employed for soil foundations will generally be invalid. Total head,
uplift pressure, and seepage quantities may be highly dependent on the type,
size, orientation, and continuity of joints and fractures in the rock and the
type and degree of treatment afforded the rock foundation during construction.
Since any joints or fractures in the rock can be detrimental to underseepage
control, the joints and fractures should be cleaned out and filled with grout
before the concrete is placed, as discussed in paragraph 7-4g. For walls on a
rock foundation, the total seepage path can be assumed to be the length of the
base which is in compression. An example of a wall on a rock foundation is
shown in example 2 of Appendix N.
3-23. Effect of Drains. Water pressures for design analyses should consider
both working drains and blocked drainage conditions. Achieving an adequate
factor of safety for an analysis considering blocked drainage is usually not
good justification for omitting drains. Preferred practice is to provide
drains; lower factors of safety than specified herein may be justified where
blocked drainage assumptions are combined with rare and/or conservative loading assumptions. All such deviations from recommended safety factors should
be supported by an assessment of expected drain reliability, and a justification that the factor of safety is reasonable in light of the analyzed
conditions. Drains are discussed further in paragraphs 6-6 and 7-4.
3-24.
a. General Criteria. Wave and water level predictions for the analysis
of walls should be determined with the criteria presented in the Shore Protection Manual (U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station 1984). Design
forces acting on the wall should be determined for the water levels and waves
predicted for the most severe fetch and the effects of shoaling, refraction,
and diffraction. A distinction is made between the action of nonbreaking,
breaking, and broken waves, where the methods recommended for calculation of
wave forces are for vertical walls. Wave forces on other types of walls
(i.e., sloping, stepped, curved, etc.) are not sufficiently understood to recommend general analytical design criteria. In any event, a coastal engineer
should be involved in establishing wave forces for the design of important
structures.
b. Wave Heights. Wave heights for design are obtained from the statistical distribution of all waves in a wave train, and are defined as follows:
H
= 1.67 H
s
1
b
c.
3-59
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
waves do not break, a nonbreaking condition exists. This occurs when the water depth at the wall is greater than approximately 1.5 times the maximum
wave height. The H
wave shall be used for the nonbreaking condition.
1
Design nonbreaking wave pressures shall be computed using the Miche-Rudgren
Method, as described in Chapter 7 of the Shore Protection Manual (U. S. Army
Engineer Waterways Experiment Station 1984). Whenever the maximum stillwater
level results in a nonbreaking condition, lower stillwater levels should be
investigated for the possibility that shallow water may produce breaking wave
forces which are larger than the nonbreaking forces.
d. Breaking Wave
steepness of the wave
tain relationships to
positioned in a water
1.3 H
s
ing process indicates that this assumption is not always valid. The height of
the breaking wave and its breaking point are difficult to determine, but
breaker height can be equal to the water depth of the structure, depending on
bottom slope and wave period. Detailed determination of breaker heights and
distances for a sloping approach grade in front of the wall are given in the
Shore Protection Manual (U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station
1984). Special consideration must be given to a situation where the fetch
shoals abruptly (as with a bulkhead wall submerged by a surge tide) near the
wall, but at a distance more than an approximate 0.7 wavelength away from the
wall, and then maintains a constant water depth from that point to the wall.
In this case waves larger than the water depth can be expected to have broken
at the abrupt shoaling point, leaving smaller, higher frequency waves to reach
the wall. Design breaking wave pressure should be determined by the Minikin
method presented in Chapter 7 of the Shore Protection Manual (U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station 1984). Breaking wave impact pressures occur
at the instant the vertical force of the wave hits the wall and only when a
plunging wave entraps a cushion of air against the wall. Because of this dependence on curve geometry, high impact pressures are infrequent against
prototype structures; however, they must be recognized and considered in
design. Also, since the high impact pressures caused by breaking waves are of
high frequency, their importance in design against sliding and overturning may
be questionable relative to longer lasting lower dynamic forces. An example
involving a breaking wave condition is shown in example 7 of Appendix N.
tion if
e. Broken Wave Condition. Broken waves are those that break before
reaching the wall but near enough to have retained some of the forward momentum of breaking. The design breaker height in this case (H ) is the highest
b
wave that will be broken in the break zone. Design wave forces for the height
H
should be determined by the method presented in Chapter 7 of the Shore
b
Protection Manual (U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station 1984).
f. Seepage Pressures. Seepage pressures are based on the elevation of
the surge stillwater level (paragraph 4-5).
3-60
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Section IV.
Supplemental Forces
3-25. Wind Load. Wind loads should be considered for retaining and flood
walls during construction, prior to placing backfill. Wind loads can act any
time in the life of a flood wall.
In locations subjected to hurricanes, a
wind load of 50 lb/sq ft can be used conservatively for walls 20 feet or less
in height for winds up to 100 miles per hour (mph).
In locations not subjected to hurricanes, 30 lb/sq ft can be used conservatively for the same
height of wall and wind velocity conditions. For more severe conditions, the
wind loads should be computed in accordance with ANSI A58.1 using a coefficient C
equal to 1.2.
f
3-26.
Earthquake Forces.
a. General. For retaining walls which are able to yield laterally during
an earthquake, the calculation of increased earth pressures induced by
earthquakes can be approximated by the Mononobe-Okabe pseudo-static approach
outlined below. In addition, the inertial forces of the wall, plus that
portion of the adjacent earth and/or water which is assumed to act with the
wall, should be included.
b. Mononobe-Okabe Analysis. This analysis is an extension of the Coulomb
sliding-wedge theory taking into account horizontal and vertical inertial
forces acting on the soil. The analysis is described in detail by Seed and
Whitman (1970) and Whitman and Liao (1985).
(1) Assumptions. The following assumptions are made by the
Mononobe-Okabe analysis:
(a) The wall is free to yield sufficiently to enable full soil strength
or active pressure conditions to be mobilized.
(b) The backfill is completely above or completely below the water table,
unless the top surface is horizontal, in which case the backfill can be partially saturated.
(c)
(d)
(e)
wedge.
(f)
Any surcharge is uniform and covers the entire surface of the soil
3-61
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
For driving (active) wedges (Figure 3-34a),
1 K (1
2 AE
PAE
KAE
cos cos2 cos (
cos2 (
) 1
kv)h 2
[3-44]
)
) sin (
) cos(
sin (
cos (
)
)
[3-45]
PPE
KPE
cos cos cos (
2
1 K (1
2 PE
cos2 (
) 1
kv)h 2
[3-46]
sin (
cos (
) sin (
) cos(
)
)
[3-47]
and P
are the combined static and dynamic forces due to the driving
AE
PE
and resisting wedges, respectively. The equations are subject to the same
limitations that are applicable to Coulombs equations. Definitions of terms
are as follows:
= unit weight of soil
k
= vertical acceleration in gs
h = height of wall
= internal friction angle of soil
kh
= tan
= seismic inertia angle
1 kv
k = horizontal acceleration in gs
h
= inclination of wall with respect to vertical (this definition of
is different from in Coulombs equations)
= wall friction angle
= inclination of soil surface (upward slopes away from the wall are
positive)
3-62
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Slip plane
a.
Slip plane
b.
Figure 3-34.
Passive wedge
3-63
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(3) Simplifying Conditions. For the usual case where
are taken to be zero, the equations reduce to:
, and
where
-1
tan
1/2 K
1/2 K
(k
h)
and
AE
PE
AE
PE
For the case when the water table is above the backfill,
and P
must
AE
PE
be divided into static and dynamic components for computing the lateral
forces. Buoyant soil weight is used for computing the static component below
the water table, with the hydrostatic force added, and saturated soil weight
is used for computing the dynamic component (see paragraph 3-26c(3)).
(4) Observations. General observations from using Mononobe-Okabe
analysis are as follows:
(a)
K
and
AE
approach each other and, for a vertical backfill face ( = 0), become
PE
equal when
(b)
= .
The locations of
and P
are not given by the Mononobe-Okabe
AE
PE
analysis. Seed and Whitman (1970) suggest that the dynamic component P
AE
be placed at the upper one-third point,
P
being the difference between
AE
P
and the total active force from Coulombs active wedge without the earthAE
quake. The general wedge earthquake analysis described in paragraph 3-26c
places the dynamic component P
at the upper one-third point also, but
AE
computes P
as being the difference between P
and the total active
AE
AE
3-64
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
force from the Mononobe-Okabe wedge.
AE
which uses the same wedge for computing the static and dynamic components of
P
, is preferred.
AE
(c) Another limitation of the Mononobe-Okabe equation is that the contents of the radical in the equation must be positive for a real solution to
be possible, and for this it is necessary that + for the driving
wedges and - for the resisting wedges. This condition could also be
thought of as specifying a limit to the horizontal acceleration coefficient
that could be sustained by any structure in a given soil. The limiting condition for the driving wedge is:
(d) Figure 3-35a (Applied Technology Council 1981) shows the effect on
the magnification factor F
(equal to
K /K ) on changes in the vertical
T
AE A
acceleration coefficient k . Positive values of k
have a significant
v
v
effect for values of k
greater than 0.2. The effect is greater than
v
10 percent above and to the right of the dashed line. For values of k
of
h
0.2 or less, k
can be neglected for all practical purposes.
v
(e)
and F
are also sensitive to variations in backfill slope,
T
AE
particularly for higher values of horizontal acceleration. This effect is
shown in Figure 3-35b.
c. General Wedge Earthquake Analysis.
When the Coulomb wedge assumptions cannot be met, the following wedge analysis can be used. The equations
for the dynamic force given below for various conditions are simply the horizontal acceleration coefficient multiplied by the weight of the wedge defined
by the critical slip-plane angle. See example 11 of Appendix M for sample
calculations.
(1) Assumptions. The equations for determining the critical slip-plane
angle for driving and resisting wedges subjected to a horizontal acceleration
are developed with the following assumptions:
(a)
(b) The shear strength along the potential slip planes in the soil has
not been mobilized to any extent, i.e., for static loading prior to an
earthquake.
3-65
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-35.
Influence of k
and on magnification factor
v
(after Applied Technology Council 1981)
3-66
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2) Equations for Cohesionless, Dry Backfill Above the Water Table.
Driving and resisting forces for cohesionless, dry, sloping planar-surfaced
backfill below the water table where k , , and = 0 can be computed as
v
follows:
(a) Static Components.
wedge are:
where
3-67
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
If k
> 0 , replace
with (1 - k ).
v
(b)
Dynamic Components.
(c)
AE
3-68
, which cause
to be small,
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
P
AE
PE
(3) Equations for Cohesionless Backfill with Water Table. Driving and
resisting forces for cohesionless, sloping, planar-surfaced backfill with
water table where k , , and = 0 can be computed as follows:
v
(a) Driving Force. The static components for a driving wedge are (see
Figures 3-36a and 3-37a):
and the dynamic components are (see Figures 3-36a and 3-37a):
3-69
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-36.
3-70
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-37.
3-71
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
giving a total force of:
where
and
(b) Resisting Force. The static components for the resisting wedge are
(see Figures 3-36b and 3-37b):
3-72
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
, and
and
(4) Equations for Cohesive Backfill with Water Table. Driving and resisting forces for a cohesive, sloping, planar-surfaced backfill with water
table where k , , and = 0 can be computed as follows:
v
(a) Driving Force.
Figure 3-38a):
3-73
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
= moist unit weight of fill
3-74
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-38.
3-75
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(b) Resisting Force.
(Figure 3-38b):
where
, and
and
3-76
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d. Inertia Force of Wall. The inertia force of the wall, including that
portion of the backfill above the heel or toe of the wall and any water within
the backfill which is not included as part of the Coulomb wedge, is computed
by multiplying the selected acceleration coefficient by the weight of the wall
and backfill. This force is obtained by multiplying the mass by acceleration
as follows:
where
3-77
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 3-39.
The
below
3-78
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
practical purposes. When the vertical acceleration coefficient is included in
the analysis, it is normally taken as two-thirds of the horizontal acceleration coefficient.
(2) Acceleration Coefficients Greater than 0.2. When the design acceleration coefficient exceeds 0.2, the Mononobe-Okabe analysis may require the
size of the wall to be excessively great. To provide a more economical structure, design for a small tolerable lateral displacement rather than no lateral
displacement may be preferable (Applied Technology Council 1981). A method
for computing the magnitude of relative wall displacement during a given
earthquake is described by Whitman and Liao (1985).
(3) Acceleration Coefficients for Walls Forming Part of a Dam. For retaining walls forming part of a dam, where failure of the wall would jeopardize the safety of the dam, the selection of the acceleration coefficients for
the design of the wall should be consistent with those used for the stability
analyses and concrete design of the dam, where required (ER 1110-2-1806).
3-79
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 4
STRUCTURE STABILITY
4-1. Scope. This chapter presents information for stability analysis of retaining walls and inland and coastal flood walls. The methods of analysis to
determine overturning and sliding stability and to assess bearing capacity are
discussed. The forces as determined in Chapter 3 are used to assess overturning stability and bearing capacity. In certain cases as described in this
chapter, the same forces computed for overturning may be used to check sliding
stability. In other cases, sliding stability should be computed by the multiple wedge iterative method or by an adjustment of the driving and resisting
wedge forces based on the factor of safety required, both of which are discussed in this chapter. Loading conditions for the various types of walls and
the acceptable criteria for each loading condition are given for each of the
stability analyses.
Section I.
Loading Conditions
Retaining Walls.
a. Case R1, Usual Loading. The backfill is in place to the final elevation; surcharge loading, if present, is applied (stability should be checked
with and without the surcharge); the backfill is dry, moist, or partially saturated as the case may be; any existing lateral and uplift pressures due to
water are applied. This case also includes the usual loads possible during
construction which are not considered short-duration loads.
b. Case R2, Unusual Loading. This case is the same as Case R1 except the
water table level in the backfill rises, for a short duration, or another type
of loading of short duration is applied; e.g., high wind loads
(paragraph 3-25), equipment surcharges during construction, etc.
c. Case R3, Earthquake Loading. This is the same as Case R1 with the
addition of earthquake-induced lateral and vertical loads, if applicable; the
uplift is the same as for Case R1.
4-4.
4-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
elevation; the water level is at the design flood level (top of wall less
freeboard) on the unprotected side; uplift is acting.
b. Case I2, Water to Top of Wall. This is the same as Case I1 except the
water level is at the top of the unprotected side of the wall.
c. Case I3, Earthquake Loading. The backfill is in place to the final
elevation; the water is at the usual level during the non-flood stage; uplift,
if applicable, is acting; earthquake-induced lateral and vertical loads, if
applicable, are acting. (Note: This case is necessary only if the wall has a
significant loading during the non-flood stage.)
d. Case I4, Construction Short-Duration Loading. The flood wall is in
place with the loads added which are possible during the construction period,
but are of short duration such as from strong winds (paragraph 3-25) and construction equipment surcharges.
4-5.
d. Case C2c, Broken Wave Loading. This is the same as Case C1 with a
broken wave loading added, if applicable; uplift is the same as for Case C1.
e. Case C3, Earthquake Loading. The backfill is in place to the final
elevation; water is at the usual (non-storm) level; uplift, if applicable, is
acting; earthquake-induced lateral and vertical loads, if applicable, are acting. (Note: If the wall has no significant load during the usual (non-storm)
stage, no earthquake case is necessary.)
f. Case C4, Construction Short-Duration Loading. The flood wall is in
place with the loads added which are possible during the construction period
but are of short duration, such as from strong winds and construction equipment surcharges.
g. Case C5, Wind Loading. The backfill is in place to the final elevation; water is at the usual (non-storm) level on the unprotected side; a wind
load of 50 lb/sq ft on the protected side of the wall is applied
(paragraph 3-25).
4-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Section II.
Stability Considerations
Overturning Stability
Resultant Location.
where
V = resultant base force required for vertical equilibrium
A ratio defined as the resultant ratio is computed as follows:
4-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
/
/
Foetor of
safety
a. Sliding
b.
Overturnir.g
I
I
I
~
I
I
c.
Figure 4-1.
Bearing
4-4
Table 4-1
Retaining Wall Stability Criteria
Case
No.
Loading
Condition
Sliding
Factor of
Safet:z:. FS
Overturning Criteria
Minimum Base
Area in ComEression
Soil
Rock
Foundation
Foundation
4
Rl
Usual
1.5
(Q &/or 5)2,1
Direct shear
100%
R2
Unusual
1. 33
(Q &/or
2 1
s) '
Direct shear
75%
R3
Earthquake
1.1
(Q)
Direct shear
Resultant
within
base
75%
50%
4
4
Resultant
within
base
Minimum
Bearing
Capacity
Safet;t Factor
3.0
2.0
>1.0
4-5
Notes
1.
For soil foundations which are not free draining (permeability< 10 x 10 -4 em/sec), analyze for
both Q and S strengths and design for the worst condition. For free-draining soil foundations
-4
(permeability> 10 x 10
em/sec), analyze for S strengths only.
For construction loadings in Cases R1 and R2, use Q strengths when excess pore water pressure in
the soil foundation is anticipated and S strengths when it is not anticipated.
3.
The sliding analysis of a wall on rock should be based on the frictional resistance (tan +) of
concrete on rock or rock on rock. The values should be obtained from direct shear tests of pre-cut
samples of concrete on rock and rock on rock, or direct shear tests of natural rock joints or
bedding planes.
4.
Less base area in compression than the minimum shown may be acceptable provided adequate safety
against unacceptable differential settlement and bearing failure is obtained.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2.
Test Reguired
Rock
Soil Foundation
Foundation 3
Shear
Stren~th
Overturning Criteria
Minimum Base
Area in ComEression
Soil
Rock
Foundation Foundation
4-6
Case
No.
Loading
Condition
Sliding
Factor of
Safetl': FS
II
Design flood
1.5
(Q &/or S)l
Direct shear
100%
12
Water to top
of wall
1. 33
(Q &/or S)l
Direct shear
75%
I3
Earthquake
1.1
(Q)
Direct shear
Resultant
within
base
I4
Construction
1. 33
(Q &/or S)
Direct shear
75%
4
4
75%
50%
3.0
Resultant
within
base
50%
Minimum
Bearing
Capacity
Safetl Factor
2.0
>1.0
2.0
Notes
1.
4
For soil foundations which are not free draining (permeability< 10 x 10- em/sec), analyze for
both Q and S strengths and design for the worst condition. For free-draining soil foundations
(permeability> 10 x 10
2.
For construction loading cases, use Q strengths when excess pore water pressure in the soil
foundation is anticipated and S strengths when it is not anticipated.
3.
The sliding analysis of a wall on rock should be based on the frictional resistance (tan ~) of concrete on rock or rock on rock. The values should be obtained from direct shear tests of pre-cut
samples of concrete on rock and rock on rock, or direct shear tests of natural rock joints or
bedding planes.
4.
Less base area in compression than the minimum shown may be acceptable provided adequate safety
against unacceptable differential settlement and bearing failure is obtained.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Table 4-2
Table 4-3
Coastal Flood Wall Stability Criteria
Case
No.
Loading
Condition
Cl
Surge
stillwater
C2
Wave
C2a
C2b
C2c
Nonbreaking
Breaking
Broken
1.5
1.33
(Q &/or S) 1
1. 25
(Q)4
Direct shear
60%
1. 33
(Q)4
Direct shear
5
75%
Sliding
Factor of
Safety, FS
Direct shear
4-7
C3
Earthquake
1.1
(Q)
Direct shear
C4
Construction
1. 33
(Q &/or S)2
(Q &./or S)2
Direct shear
C5
Wind
Overturning Criteria
Minimum Base
Area in ComEression
Soil
Rock
Foundation
Foundation
5
5
100%
75%
1. 33
Direct shear
75%
Resultant
within
base
5
75%
75%
50%
40%
50%
5
5
Resultant
within
base
5
50%
5
50%
Minimum
Bearing
Capacity
Safetl Factor
3.0
2.0
1.5
2.0
>1.0
2.0
2.0
Notes
1
-4
2.
3.
5.
Less base area in compression than the minimum shown may be acceptable provided adequate safety against
unacceptable differential settlement and bearing failure is obtained.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
4.
The sliding analysis of a wall on rock should be based on the frictional resistance (tan ~) of concrete on
rock or rock on rock. The values should be obtained from direct shear tests of pre-cut samples of concrete
on rock and rock on rock, or direct shear tests of natural rock joints or bedding planes.
-4
For soil foundations which are not free draining (permeability< 10 x 10
em/sec), analyze for Q test.
-4
For free draining soil foundations (permeability~ 10 x 10
em/sec), analyze for S strengths.
.!).
Wt of soil,
watter and
cohcrete In
structural
wepge
A.
I
I
I
I
.6,
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
///~~\
I
I
I
I
-lffi\
A.
4-8
Water
Effective Soil
iiii!1
T= 2.. H
Effective Soil
Water
Point 0
Uplift
l..v
Base width
Figure 4-2.
Resultant Ratio =
XR
Bose width
Wt of soilp
water and
concrete in
structural
N' = 2: Vcoso<
+2: Hstno<
wedge~
crack <see
para. 4-18 >
4-9
Water
Po
Effective Soil
Water
\\_Point 0
2:M 0
N'
Figure 4-3.
XR
=- - - - -
Base width
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Resultant Ratio
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
4-10
B= 3s
r:~ l
q
4-11
q
100% base in
compression.
Resultant within
central third
of base.
Figure 4-4.
0.500 to 0.333
0.25
0.20
0.1667
0.1333
Relationship between base width in compression and resultant location
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
100%
75%
60%
50%
40%
100% base in
compression. Resultant
at I /3 point.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Wt of soilp
water and
concrete in
structural
wedge!
crack (see
para. 4-18 )
4-12
T= 0
Point
Water
Assumed
Soil Pressure
Uplift
L Mo
LV
Base width
Figure 4-5.
Water
LV
Resultant Ratio
=___XR.;,.;.___
Base width
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with horizontal base and key
Wt of soil,
water and
concrete in
structural
wedge~
~~W~W0@W~~~'--~~~1---r-~------~~~1 ~
crock (see
para. 4-18 )
'
4-13
Point 0
Assumed
Soli Pressure
Water
Water
Uplift
Figure 4-6.
LV
Resultant Ratio =
8 ase width
Forces for overturning analysis for wall with sloping base and key
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Bose width
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Line of action
of resultant
force
S - p
(hI
h2
= Shear
force when h 1
> h2
3a
Figure 4-7.
4-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d. Uplift For Walls with Keys. For walls with keys, the soil may be
assumed to remain in contact with the key and head loss to occur around the
perimeter of the key and along the base even if the overturning analysis shows
less than 100 percent of the base in compression.
4-9. Overturning Stability Criteria. The overturning stability requirements
in Tables 4-1 through 4-3 are given as minimum percent base areas in compression. Figure 4-4 illustrates the relationship between the percent of the base
area in compression and the resultant location.
Section IV.
4-10.
Analysis Model.
(1) The shape of the failure surface may be irregular depending on the
homogeneity of the backfill and foundation material. The failure surface may
be composed of any combination of plane and curved surfaces. However, for
simplicity all failure surfaces are assumed to be planes which form the bases
of wedges as shown in Figure 4-8.
(2) Except for very simple cases, most sliding stability problems encountered in engineering practice are statically indeterminate. To reduce a
problem to a statically determinate one, the problem is simplified by dividing
the system into a number of rigid body wedges, arbitrarily assuming the direction of the moment equilibrium forces which act between the wedges, and neglecting any frictional forces between adjacent wedges.
(3) Figure 4-8 also illustrates how the failure surface would be divided
into wedges. The base of a wedge is formed from either a section of the failure surface that lies in a single soil material or along the base of the
structure. The interface between any two adjacent wedges is assumed to be a
vertical plane which extends from the intersection of the corners of the two
adjacent wedges upward to the top soil surface. The base of a wedge, the vertical interface on each side of the wedge, and the top soil surface between
the vertical interfaces define the boundaries of an individual wedge.
(4) In the sliding analysis, the retaining or flood wall and the surrounding soil are assumed to act as a system of wedges as shown in Figure 4-8.
The soil-structure system is divided into one or more driving wedges, one
structural wedge, and one or more resisting wedges.
4-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Driving
wedges
S-tructural wedge
Al-ternate planes
below structure
are analyzed to
determine critical
failure path.
Assumed
slip
planes---"""""'
a.
I
Failure plane for wall without a key
Drivin
wedges
Structuralwed e
Resisting
edg~
I
i
!
'
Al-terna-te planes
below structure
are analyzed to
determine critical
failure path.
Assumed
slip
pIan e s ------!!l~
I
I
1/
--
---
--I
I
::::::. _______ _v /
b.
Figure 4-8.
4-16
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(5) Depending on the geologic conditions of the foundation material, the
the location of the total failure surface or parts of the failure surface may
be predetermined. The inclination of some of the failure planes or the starting elevation of the failure planes adjacent to the structure may be known due
to natural constraints at the site. Conditions which warrant the predetermination of parts of the failure surface include bedding planes or cracks in a
rock foundation.
c. Analysis Procedure of the Soil-Structure System. An iterative procedure can be used to find the critical failure surface. For an assumed factor
of safety, the inclination of the base of each wedge is varied to produce a
maximum driving force for a driving wedge or a minimum resisting force for a
resisting wedge. The assumed factor of safety affects the critical inclination of the base of each wedge. The factor of safety is varied until a failure surface is produced that satisfies equilibrium. The failure surface which
results from this procedure will be the one with the lowest factor of safety.
Several base inclinations of the structural wedge, such as those shown in Figure 4-8, should be evaluated to determine the failure surface which has the
lowest factor of safety.
4-11.
Definition.
4-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
or for
= 0 ,
where
tan
4-12.
4-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a...
0:::
:::c
..c::
-1-1
r-1
\4-l
1-1
bO
ell
r-1
'tl
,<I
' <I
<1
<1
'
:>.
'tl
0
,.0
Cl)
Cl)
1-1
.....J
:::c
a...I
4-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c. Force Equilibrium Only. Only force equilibrium is satisfied. Moment
equilibrium is not considered. The shearing force acting parallel to the interface of any two wedges is assumed to be negligible. Therefore, the portion
of the slip surface at the bottom of each wedge is loaded only by the forces
directly above or below it. There is no interaction of vertical effects between the wedges. The resulting wedge forces are assumed horizontal.
d. Displacements. Considerations regarding displacements are excluded
from the limit equilibrium approach. The relative rigidity of different
foundation materials supporting the structure and the concrete structure itself may influence the results of the sliding stability analysis. Such complex structure-foundation systems may require a more intensive sliding
investigation than a limit equilibrium approach. The effects of strain compatibility along the assumed slip surface may be approximated in the limit
equilibrium approach by selecting the shear strength parameters from in situ
or laboratory tests consistent with the failure strain selected for the stiffest material.
e. Relationship Between Shearing and Normal Forces. A linear relationship is assumed between the resisting shearing force and the normal force acting on the slip plane beneath each wedge. This relationship is determined by
the Mohr-Coulomb failure criterion.
f. Structural Wedge. The general wedge equation is based on the assumption that shearing forces do not act on the vertical wedge boundaries. Hence,
there can only be one structural wedge since concrete structures transmit
significant shearing forces across vertical internal planes. Discontinuities
in the slip path beneath the structural wedge should be modeled by assuming an
average slip plane along the base of the structural wedge.
g. Interface of Other Wedges with Structural Wedge. The interface between the group of driving wedges and the structural wedge is assumed to be a
vertical plane located at the heel of the structural wedge and extending to
the base of the structural wedge. The interface between the group of resisting wedges and the structural wedge is assumed to be a vertical plane located
at the toe of the structural wedge and extending to the base of the structural
wedge.
4-13.
a.
th
(1) The geometry and sign convention of a typical i
wedge and adjacent
wedges are shown in Figure 4-10. The equations for the sliding stability of a
general wedge system are derived using a right-hand coordinate system. The
origin of each wedge is located at the lower left corner of the wedge. The
x-axis is horizontal and the y-axis is vertical.
(2) Axes which are tangent (t) and normal (n) to a failure plane are
inclined at an angle () to the +x- and +y-axes. A negative angle is formed
4-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
+y
+y
POSITIVE ROTATION
OF AXES
+t
NEGATIVE ROTATION
OF AXES
ith WEDGE
<STRUCTURAL
WEDGEl
Figure 4-10.
th
Geometry of typical i
4-21
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
from a clockwise rotation of the axes.
counterclockwise rotation of the axes.
b.
Derivation.
solving for (P
i-1
where
i = number of wedge being analyzed
(P
i-1
th
- P ) = summation of applied forces acting horizontally on the i
i
wedge. (A negative value for this term indicates that the
th
applied forces acting on the i
wedge exceed the forces
resisting sliding along the base of the wedge. A positive
value for this term indicates that the applied forces acting
th
on the i
wedge are less than the forces resisting sliding
along the base of the wedge.)
th
th
4-22
wedge
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
tan
di
= tan /FS
i
=
i
th
angle between slip plane of the i
wedge and the
horizontal (positive is counterclockwise)
c/FS
Li
Ri
di
L
th
th
wedge
wedge
Slip-Plane Angle.
-1
where = tan
(tan /FS) .
d
can be approximated by:
b. Computation of Critical Slip Plane Angle. The above equations for the
slip-plane angle are the exact solutions for wedges with a horizontal top
surface with or without a uniform surcharge. Other methods to calculate the
4-23
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
critical slip angle, for conditions other than a horizontal top surface with
or without a uniform surcharge, may be found in paragraph 3-13.
4-15.
where
T = resultant of sliding resistance parallel to the assumed
sliding plane required for equilibrium
N = resultant of forces normal to the assumed sliding plane
tan and c = unfactored shear strength parameters of the foundation
material through which the sliding plane passes
4-24
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
L = length of sliding plane beneath the structure
FS = minimum sliding factor of safety required
If the assumed sliding plane is horizontal, T would equal the resultant of
the horizontal forces and N would equal the resultant of the vertical
forces. See example 1 in Appendix N.
(4) If Equation 4-12 is not satisfied, perform a multiple wedge analysis
to determine the actual sliding factor of safety (see the following
paragraph).
(5) The necessity for a multiple wedge solution may be eliminated if the
driving and resisting wedge forces are calculated using the minimum FS required. If Equation 4-12 is not satisfied for the FS required, a multiple
wedge solution will show the same results. If Equation 4-12 is satisfied, the
system has an FS equal to or greater than the minimum FS required.
4-16.
a.
Procedure.
(1) Divide the assumed sliding mass into a number of wedges, including a
single structural wedge, based on the configuration and discontinuities of the
backfill, wall proportions, and discontinuities of the foundation.
(2)
Estimate the
FS
(3) Compute the critical sliding angles for each wedge. For a driving
wedge, the critical angle is the angle that produces a maximum driving force.
For a resisting wedge, the critical angle is the angle that produces a minimum
resisting force.
(4) Compute the uplift pressures, if any, along the slip plane.
effects of seepage should be included.
(5)
The
Compute the weight of the wedges, including any water and surcharges.
(6) Compute the summation of the lateral forces for each wedge using the
general wedge equation. In certain cases where the loadings or wedge geometries are complicated, the critical angles of the wedges may not be easily
calculated. The general wedge equation may be used to iterate and find the
critical angle of a wedge by varying the angle of the wedge to find a minimum
resisting or maximum driving force.
(7)
(8) If the sum of the lateral forces is negative, decrease the FS and
recompute the sum of the lateral forces. By decreasing the FS, a greater
4-25
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
4-26
N'
=:l:Vcos ex
+ L: HsinCX
Figure 4-11.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
percentage of the shearing strength along the slip planes is mobilized. If
the sum of the lateral forces is positive, increase the FS and recompute the
sum of the lateral forces. By increasing the FS, a smaller percentage of the
shearing strength is mobilized.
(9) Continue this trial-and-error process until the sum of the lateral
forces is approximately zero for the FS used. This will determine the FS that
causes the sliding mass to be in horizontal equilibrium.
(10) If the FS is less than the minimum required, redesign by widening or
sloping the base or by providing a key.
b. Computer Program. The computer program CSLIDE (Appendix O) can assist
in performing a multiple wedge sliding analysis.
4-17. Sliding Stability Criteria. The sliding stability criteria are given
in terms of a minimum factor of safety for the various loading conditions as
shown in Tables 4-1 through 4-3. Guidance on deep-seated sliding is given in
Chapter 5.
4-18.
Design Considerations.
where
c
= c/FS
= tan
-1
(tan /FS)
(see Equation 3-11)
The value
in a cohesive foundation
c
and the depth of cracking in massive strong rock foundations should be assumed
to extend to the base of the structural wedge. The depth of cracking in a
level clay blanket should be computed using Equation 4-13. Full hydrostatic
pressure should be assumed to act at the bottom of the crack. The hydraulic
gradient across the base of the structural wedge should reflect the presence
of a crack at the heel of the structural wedge. Examples showing the calculation of d
are found in Appendix N in examples 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7.
c
4-27
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b. Passive Resistance. When passive resistance is used, special considerations must be made. Rock or soil that may be subjected to high velocity
water scouring should not be used unless amply protected. Also, the compressive strength of rock layers must be sufficient to develop the wedge resistance. In some cases, wedge resistance should not be assumed without
resorting to special treatment, such as rock anchors.
Section V.
4-19. General Computations. The bearing capacity is checked for the same
loading conditions as determined by the overturning analysis for each case
analyzed. The bearing capacity should be checked along the same plane assumed
in the sliding analysis. A normal (N) and tangent (T) force are calculated
for the structural wedge along the assumed bearing plane. These forces are
shown in Figure 4-11. T and N are used in combination to check the bearing capacity. The bearing capacity analysis discussed in Chapter 5 and in the
CBEAR Users Guide (Mosher and Pace 1982) (see Appendix O) considers both the
normal and tangent components of the resultant force at the base of the structure. The factor of safety against a bearing failure can be computed by
dividing the normal component of the ultimate bearing capacity by the effective normal force applied to the structural wedge as shown below:
where
Q = normal component of the ultimate bearing capacity
N = effective normal force applied to the structural wedge
The value computed from the general bearing capacity equation in Chapter 5 is
the bearing capacity normal to the base of the structure. The computer program CBEAR (Appendix O) can assist in performing a bearing capacity analysis.
Example calculations are shown in Appendix N.
4-20. Inadequate Bearing Capacity. If the factor of safety against bearing
failure is insufficient, consideration should be given to increasing the width
of the base, lowering the base of the wall, or founding the wall on piles.
4-21. Bearing Capacity Criteria. The criteria for bearing capacity are given
in terms of a factor of safety as defined in paragraph 4-19 and shown in
Tables 4-1 through 4-3.
Section VI.
4-22. Design Procedures. Figure 4-12 presents a summary of the design procedures discussed in this chapter.
4-28
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
NO TEo
~-------1110----------------~~
NO
Figure 4-12.
4-29
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 5
FOUNDATION ANALYSES
Section I.
5-1.
Factor of Safety.
The
FS
is calculated as follows:
where
N = effective normal force applied to the base of the structure
Q = normal component to the base of the structure of the ultimate
bearing capacity
The minimum acceptable bearing capacity factors for retaining walls and inland
and coastal flood walls are listed by loading case in Tables 4-1 through 4-3.
For each loading case, the same loadings as determined by the overturning
analysis should be used. Options to consider in the event of inadequate bearing capacity have been presented in paragraph 4-20.
5-2. General Bearing Capacity Equation.
tion for a strip footing is:
5-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
Q =
_
B =
B =
e =
c =
Figure 5-1 illustrates the meanings of all of the terms required to use the
information given in paragraphs 5-3 through 5-8. The general bearing capacity
equation is taken from the CBEAR users guide (Mosher and Pace 1982) (see also
Appendix O). The appropriate soil foundation shear strength for retaining
walls and inland and coastal flood walls is listed, by loading case, in
Tables 4-1 through 4-3.
5-3. Bearing Capacity Factors. Bearing capacity factors for a horizontal
strip footing under vertical loading are:
5-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Po
I'
I
I
I
I
I
'
-,
I'
'
L',
r--
'
I'
'
,, I - I)
'
D
\
,, 8
N'
(r
Horizontal base
---~
\
\
a'\
\~'
b.
Figure 5-1.
5-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Bearing capacity factor values for
given in Table 5-1.
5-4. Embedment Factors. Embedment factors take into consideration the shearing resistance along the foundation slip plane that exists in the soil above
the base of the footing, on the toe side of a wall. These factors can be
computed as:
When lies between 0 and 10 degrees, a linear interpolation can be made for
Where is the angle that the line of action of the load makes with a line
drawn normal to the base. If > ,
should be set equal to zero.
i
5-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Table 5-1
Bearing Capacity Factors (CBEAR Users Guide)*
N
q
tan
0
1
2
3
4
5.14
5.38
5.63
5.90
6.19
1.00
1.09
1.20
1.31
1.43
0.00
0.00
0.01
0.02
0.04
0.0000
0.0175
0.0349
0.0524
0.0699
1.0000
1.0355
1.0723
1.1105
1.1500
5
6
7
8
9
6.49
6.81
7.16
7.53
7.92
1.57
1.72
1.88
2.06
2.25
0.07
0.11
0.15
0.21
0.28
0.0875
0.1051
0.1228
0.1405
0.1584
1.1910
1.2335
1.2776
1.3233
1.3709
10
11
12
13
14
8.34
8.80
9.28
9.81
10.37
2.47
2.71
2.97
3.26
3.59
0.37
0.47
0.60
0.74
0.92
0.1763
0.1944
0.2126
0.2309
0.2493
1.4203
1.4716
1.5250
1.5805
1.6382
15
16
17
18
19
10.98
11.63
12.34
13.10
13.93
3.94
4.34
4.77
5.26
5.80
1.13
1.37
1.66
2.00
2.40
0.2679
0.2867
0.3057
0.3249
0.3443
1.6984
1.7610
1.8263
1.8944
1.9655
20
21
22
23
24
14.83
15.82
16.88
18.05
19.32
6.40
7.07
7.82
8.66
9.60
2.87
3.42
4.07
4.82
5.72
0.3640
0.3839
0.4040
0.4245
0.4452
2.0396
2.1171
2.1980
2.2826
2.3712
25
26
27
28
29
20.72
22.25
23.94
25.80
27.86
10.66
11.85
13.20
14.72
16.44
6.77
8.00
9.46
11.19
13.24
0.4663
0.4877
0.5095
0.5317
0.5543
2.4639
2.5611
2.6629
2.7698
2.8821
(Continued)
5-5
( )
N
c
tan
45+
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Table 5-1 (Concluded)
N
c
N
q
tan
tan
( )
45+
30
31
32
33
34
30.14
32.67
35.49
38.64
42.16
18.40
20.63
23.18
26.09
29.44
15.67
18.56
22.02
26.17
31.15
0.5774
0.6009
0.6249
0.6494
0.6745
3.0000
3.1240
3.2546
3.3921
3.5371
35
36
37
38
39
46.12
50.59
55.63
61.35
67.87
33.30
37.75
42.92
48.93
55.96
37.15
44.43
53.27
64.08
77.33
0.7002
0.7265
0.7536
0.7813
0.8098
3.6902
3.8518
4.0228
4.2037
4.3955
40
41
42
43
44
75.31
83.86
93.71
105.11
118.37
64.20
73.90
85.38
99.02
115.31
93.69
113.99
139.32
171.15
211.41
0.8391
0.8693
0.9004
0.9325
0.9657
4.5989
4.8149
5.0447
5.2893
5.5500
45
46
47
48
49
50
133.88
152.10
173.64
199.26
229.93
266.89
134.88
158.51
187.21
222.31
265.51
319.07
262.75
328.74
414.34
526.47
674.94
873.88
1.0000
1.0355
1.0724
1.1106
1.1504
1.1918
5.8284
6.1260
6.4447
6.7865
7.1536
7.5486
5-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
5-6. Base Tilt Factors. These factors are used to take into account the
effect of a sloping base. The base tilt factors are computed as:
where is the angle the slip plane of the structural wedge makes with the
horizontal, measured in radians. The sign of will follow the sign convention given in Chapter 4.
5-7. Ground Slope Factors. Ground slope factors are used to correct for a
sloping ground surface on the toe side of the wall. The factors are computed
as:
where is the angle the ground surface makes with the horizontal, measured
in radians. is positive when the ground slopes down and away from the
footing.
5-8.
5-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
= effective unit weight of the overlying soil
D = depth from the soil surface to the base of the structural wedge
For the special case of a sloping surface, compute
as:
Other Considerations
Settlement.
5-8
Arc Center
5-9
0
Figure 5-2.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Arc Center
/#N~'
\
\
0:
\.
\
I
I
\.
____ SZ_ __\ - -
----r-----
\
\
5-10
\
\
I
I
I
/#ffl/1~'
a1 "
0 //.
8 /.//
I
as
Weak Soil
a3
Figure 5-3.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
investigated. This may be assumed to occur below the base of the retaining or
flood wall along a cylindrical surface passing through the heel (Figure 5-4).
The minimum factor of safety, which must not be less than 1.5, is determined by
trial and error by changing the center of the trial circle.
Figure 5-4.
5-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b.
5-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 6
DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION DETAILS AND CAUSES OF
UNSATISFACTORY PERFORMANCE
6-1. Foundation Preparation. Earth foundations should be properly compacted
and should be clean and damp before concrete is placed. Rock foundations
should be cleaned and given any other necessary treatment to ensure proper bond
of concrete to rock. Some rock foundations, primarily shales, require a
protective covering such as unreinforced concrete to protect them from deterioration after being exposed and before concrete placement, unless the final
excavation can be performed close enough in time to the placement of the
structural base slab. When a protective coating is used, it must be such as to
ensure proper bond.
6-2. Concrete Materials. Consideration should be given to the materials that
are economically available for a particular project. EM 1110-2-2000 describes
concrete materials requirements; all options which are applicable to the work
and which include available materials should be investigated. Concrete proportions should be selected to satisfy strength and durability requirements.
6-3. Constructability. The dimensions of the wall should be such that reinforcement and concrete can be properly placed. EM 1110-2-2000 provides guidance for concrete placement. Guide specifications CW 03301 and CW 03305
provide detail requirements for concrete placement. The top thickness of the
stem for cantilever concrete walls over 8 feet high and for base slabs should
be a minimum of 12 inches to facilitate concrete placement. Stems not over
8 feet high with one layer of vertical reinforcement may be 8 inches thick.
The wall section should be designed for simplicity and maximum reuse of forms.
Any construction constraints due to the location of the wall should be included
in the design.
6-4. Joints. Walls are designed with joints to allow for expansion, contraction, and/or to divide the structure into convenient working units. The locations of all horizontal and vertical joints should be shown on the drawings.
a.
Expansion Joints.
(1) General Needs and Uses. Expansion joints are designed to prevent
the crushing and distortion (including displacement, buckling, and warping) of
the abutting concrete structural units that might otherwise occur due to the
transmission of compressive forces. Compressive forces may be developed by
expansion, applied loads, or differential movements arising from the configuration of the structure or its settlement. In general, expansion joints are
needed to prevent spalling and sometimes to break continuity. In relatively
thin reinforced concrete walls such joints should be located where considerable expansion or unequal settlement is anticipated, e.g., at changes in
alignment or grade, at abrupt changes in section or at intermediate points
when needed. In massive reinforced concrete walls and in gravity walls on
rock, expansion joints usually are not provided unless required at abrupt
6-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
changes in section or at angle monoliths to relieve thrust from expected expansion. Otherwise, adequate chamfers on each side of each contraction joint
usually are sufficient to prevent spalling. Where temperature variations are
extreme, modification of these criteria may be required. Reinforcing steel,
corner protection angles, and other fixed metal embedded in or bonded to the
surface of the concrete should not extend through an expansion joint. Where
water tightness is needed, water stops are provided as outlined in
paragraph 6-4e.
(2) Joint Filler. The thickness of joint filler necessary to provide
stress relief at a joint should be determined from the estimated initial contraction and subsequent expansion from maximum temperature variation. Premolded expansion joint filler and adequate chamfers should be used.
b. Contraction (Monolith) Joints. These are intentional planes of weakness designed to regulate cracking that might otherwise occur due to the unavoidable, often unpredictable, contraction of concrete structural units.
Contraction joints also divide the structure into convenient working units and
thus also serve as construction joints. Since it is impractical and uneconomical to provide sufficient reinforcement to prevent cracks entirely, it is
desirable to control their location, insofar as is practicable, by vertical
contraction joints, across which reinforcement does not extend. No exact rules
for the location of such joints can be made. Each job must be studied to
determine where the joints should be placed, taking into account the requirements of structural design, the volume of concrete which can be placed
economically in a single working unit, and the economical use of form units.
Typically, contraction joints have been spaced 20 to 30 feet apart. Usually, a
contraction joint has a plane surface without a key. For cantilever concrete
walls, vertical contraction joints may be located only in the stem, and the
footing may be a continuous placement.
c. Horizontal Construction Joints. These joints are provided to divide a
wall into convenient working units, but they should be kept to a minimum. Keys
are not permitted in horizontal construction joints as they interfere with good
cleanup of the concrete surface and because a well-bonded flat surface is more
dependable to transfer shear.
(1) Gravity Concrete Walls. For this type of wall the horizontal construction joint locations are dictated by the height of each lift of concrete
placement. Concrete for gravity walls is usually placed in lifts up to 10 feet
high. The top surface of each lift is cleaned and roughened by high-pressure
water jets before placing the next lift.
(2) Cantilever Concrete Walls. For this type of wall a construction
joint between the base and the wall stem should be provided. Additional horizontal joints in the wall stem should be provided by lifts approximately
10 feet high. The surface of each joint should be roughened to obtain as much
shear strength across the joint as possible.
6-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d. Joint Details for Flood Walls. For expansion and contraction joint
details for flood walls, see paragraph 7-14.
e. Water Stops. Water stops are provided across joints where watertightness is required. Nonmetallic water stops, such as rubber or polyvinyl
chloride (PVC) water stops, should be used in accordance with EM 1110-2-2102.
For special flood wall water stop details, see Chapter 7, Sections II and V.
Careful inspection is required for water stop installation, especially with the
type "U" water stop (Figure 7-9b), to see that special reinforcing is properly
placed and that concrete is placed under the upper water stop in the base slab.
6-5.
Soil Backfill.
6-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
6-6.
Drainage.
Figure 6-1.
6-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
minimize excess hydrostatic pressures on the failure plane due to groundwater
seepage and surface infiltration of rainfall. A drain adjacent to the wall is
less effective and will often result in higher loads against the wall (see
Figure 6-2). However, for relatively low walls (typically less than 10 feet
high), these higher loads may not be significant, and drains adjacent to the
wall are often used. Drains adjacent to the wall may be either a drainage
blanket (Figure 6-3) or a prefabricated drainage composite* (Figure 6-4).
Where frost penetration is a problem, a drainage system as shown in Figure 6-5
should be used. If a cohesive soil backfill is used, a drainage system as
shown in Figure 6-6 will prevent changes in moisture content of the clay and
hence reduce cracking and swelling potential. Other seepage control methods
are discussed in paragraph 7-4.
c. Longitudinal Drains. Longitudinal drains within drainage blankets are
used for carrying the discharge from behind the retaining wall to a ditch,
manhole, or other free exit. Drains should be large enough to carry the
discharge and have adequate slope to provide sufficient velocity to remove
sediment from the drain.** To minimize clogging, the drain should have
perforations in the bottom half of the pipe at least 22.5 degrees below the
horizontal axis. Where the operation of the drains is counted on to reduce the
design loadings, manholes and/or inspection holes (see Figure 6-7) should be
located at sufficient intervals, and at any sharp bends in the pipe, to
facilitate inspection and cleanout. The terminus of the drain should have a
vertical check valve (see Figure 6-8) to prevent backflooding. The end section
of pipe supporting the check valve should be secured with a coupling band which
can be removed for inspection and cleaning of the pipe.
d. Weepholes. Weepholes should consist of a pipe, at least 3 inches in
diameter, extending through the stem of the wall. They should be protected
against clogging by pockets of gravel in the soil backfill or by the use of
filter fabric adjacent to the wall directly behind the weepholes. The weepholes are commonly spaced not more than 10 feet apart vertically and
horizontally.
e. Filter Requirements. Drains should be adequately protected by filter
layers so that seepage water is admitted freely but movement of the soil backfill into the drain will not occur. The piping or stability criterion is
**
Whenever a prefabricated drainage composite is used adjacent to the retaining wall, the crushing strength of the prefabricated drainage
composite should be greater than three times the maximum lateral earth
pressure acting on the wall. Prefabricated drainage composites are not
recommended for inclined drains due to possible damage during compaction
of the soil backfill and possible sliding along the plane of the drain
(Smith and Kraemer 1987, Kraemer and Smith 1986).
For a 6-inch-diameter pipe the minimum slope would be about 0.15 percent
(Schwab et al. 1981).
6-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
POTENTIAL FAILURE PLANE
WATER PRESSURE
DISTRIBUTION ON
POTENTIAL FAILURE
PLANE DUE TO
STEADY SEEPAGE.
'V
NOTE INCREASE IN
WATER PRESSURE ON
POTENTIAL FAILURE
PLANE DUE TO
SURFACE INFILTRATION.
Figure 6-2.
6-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 6-3.
6-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 6-4.
Figure 6-5.
6-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 6-6.
6-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
B"DIA
PERFC.M.P.
GUARD
POST --::1~~-!-
B"DIA
PERFC.M.P.
!
22'"0/A
FINISH
GRADE
GUARD POST
GAL V STD PIPE
PAINT YELLOW
INVELEV
NOT TO SCALE
Figure 6-7.
6-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 6-8.
based on the grain size relationship between the protected soil and the filter
where
D
15
85
6-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
and
where
D
50
50
To assure that the filter material is more permeable than the material being
drained, the following condition must be met:
To prevent clogging of perforated longitudinal drains, the following requirement must be satisfied:
Circular openings
Slotted openings
The filter material may satisfy the criteria for stability and permeability
but may be too fine to meet the criteria for circular or slotted openings.
Should this happen, multilayered or graded filters are required. It may be
possible to substitute filter fabric for one or more of the granular filters
in a multilayered filter system. Filter cloth shall conform to the
6-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
requirements of guide specification CW 02215.
f. Drain Requirements. The drain must be able to carry the design flow
freely without movement of soil particles. Drainage blankets may be constructed of clean sand and gravel or a prefabricated drainage composite (for
certain applications). The design flow can be determined from a flow net
(Cedergren 1967). For isotropic soil conditions:
where
q
f
d
where
k
d
d
6-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 6-9.
Construction Considerations.
(1) Sand and Gravel. Sand and gravel must not become segregated or
contaminated prior to, during, or after installation. Segregation will result
in zones of material too fine to meet the permeability requirements and other
zones too coarse to meet the stability requirements. Contamination of the
filter material from muddy water, dust, etc., during construction may clog the
voids in the material and prevent proper drainage. In the event that filter or
drain materials are contaminated, they should be replaced. Filter materials
subject to cementation should be rejected.
(2) Prefabricated Drainage Composite. Special consideration should be
given when compacting soil backfill near prefabricated drainage composites
adjacent to retaining walls. Compaction adjacent to the retaining wall will
induce high lateral pressures which could crush the prefabricated drainage
6-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
composite and/or reduce the inplane permeability. The drainage composite
manufactures recommendations for backfilling and compaction near the composite
should be followed. A test section may be required to determine the acceptable
operating conditions of the compaction equipment. Where crushed stone is used
as the backfill material, a blanket of sand should be provided against the
drainage composite to protect it against damage during compaction.
(3) Longitudinal Drains. One bad joint could render an entire drainage
system inoperative. Care must be taken in compacting soil backfill over drains
to prevent crushing of the pipe. Differential settlement can cause pipe joints
to open up, permitting soil backfill to infiltrate. This should be minimized
by attaining uniform adequate compaction of the underlying material.
6-7. Causes of Unsatisfactory Performance. The results of two statistical
studies of retaining wall failures are given in Figure 6-10 (Tcheng and Iseux
1972, Ireland 1964). It is evident that:
a. Clay, as backfill or foundation material, is involved in most retaining wall failures.
b. Improper design of the drainage system and/or the wall base is the
main cause of retaining wall failure.
6-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
UNSATISFACTORY DIMENSIONING
OF WALL BASE
MISSING OR INADEOUA TE
DRAINAGE SYSTEM
COULD NOT BE
CLASSIFIED _ ____...,...
CARELESS
CONSTRUCTION
STRUCTURAL FAILURE
OF STEM
FAULTY BACKFILLING
a.
BACKFILL UNKNOWN
FOUNDATION: UNKNOWN
BACKFILL: CLAY
FOUNDATION: CLAY
BACKFILL: CLAY
FOUNDATION: SAND,
GRAVEL, ROCK
BACKFILL: UNKNOWN
FOUNDATION: CLAY
BACKFILL: SAND, GRAVEL
FOUNDATION: CLAY
b.
Figure 6-10.
6-16
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 7
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS FOR FLOOD WALLS
Section I.
General Characteristics
(1) The hydraulic data required for determining the design water level
should be listed in the hydrologic/hydraulic appendix of the pertinent planning
document for the project. The flow characteristics noted in historical records
and indicated from detailed observation of existing conditions will usually be
basic to the design of inland flood walls. Coastal flood walls will frequently
require hurricane surge simulation studies and wave setup estimates. Wave
overtopping can cause severe scour at or near the protected side of the stem.
See paragraph 3-24 for information on surge and wave loads.
(2) Factors that influence the water surface profile and level of protection, and that can reasonably be quantified, are included in the design
water level; not the freeboard. Some examples of these factors are:
(a) Changed conveyance, due to changing bed form, sedimentation or scour,
and vegetation growth or removal.
(b)
(c)
(d) Transverse slope due to water flowing out of or into the channel or
differences in velocity head between the channel and overbank locations.
(e)
7-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(f) Energy losses due to changing flow area, e.g. constrictions
(bridges), abrupt expansions, and bends.
(g)
(a) Assurance of initial overtopping at the most desirable (least hazardous) location.
(b)
7-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c. Loading Cases. For determining water and soil loads acting on flood
walls, refer to Chapter 3. Section I of Chapter 4 discusses loading cases.
Section II.
Seepage Control
7-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 7-1.
7-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Water Side
Q)
......
Land Side
(f)
Ground Line
~-Toe
Drain
Heel
F--it--
Base Width
Sheet Pile
Cutoff (Optional)
7-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
procedures are contained in EM 1110-2-1913 and WES Technical Memorandum 3-424
(US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, 1956). In some instances,
where complex problems of geometry, anisotropy, and foundation layering exist,
flow nets and/or finite element seepage analyses may be necessary. Types of
underseepage control measures are described in the following paragraphs.
Additional discussion is given in paragraphs 3-23 and 6-6.
a. Cutoffs. A cutoff penetrating the pervious stratum beneath the wall
is the most positive means of controlling seepage. A cutoff can consist of an
excavated trench backfilled with impervious compacted earth, a slurry trench,
an extension of a concrete shear key, or a sheet pile wall. A cutoff is
usually located at the end of the wall footing on the unprotected (heel) side.
A cutoff must penetrate approximately 95 percent or more of the pervious strata
before significant reductions in the quantity of flow can be realized; however,
partial cutoffs can be somewhat effective in reducing uplift pressures on the
wall base. Deep cutoffs will often interfere with the normal exchange of
groundwater between an aquifer and a river during non-flood periods and should
only be considered where detailed hydrogeologic studies have been made in this
regard. The decision as to the type and depth of a cutoff should be based on
an underseepage analysis considering actual site conditions. A steel sheet
pile cutoff is not entirely watertight due to leakage at the interlocks but can
significantly reduce the possibility of piping of coarse-grained material in
the foundation. The effectiveness of a properly interlocked steel sheet pile
cutoff through a coarse-grained stratum in reducing uplift can be assumed to be
up to 50 percent. The design uplift diagram, as shown in Figure 7-3, should be
drawn with a pressure head at point B on the unprotected side of the the cutoff
equal to the full head of water on the unprotected side (neglecting any reduction in pressure due to head loss from seepage effects). The pressure head on
the protected side of the cutoff at point B should equal the pressure at
point B reduced by up to 50 percent of the difference between the full head
value on the unprotected side and the pressure head at the end of the toe of
the wall. The pressure head at the toe of the wall can be computed based on
the seepage path from the cutoff wall to the saturated level on the protected
side. If the effectiveness of the steel sheet pile cutoff is assumed to be
greater than 50 percent, it should be based on actual experience of similar
conditions and justified accordingly. An example of a flood wall with a sheet
pile cutoff is shown in example 5 of Appendix N. A sheet pile cutoff is less
effective in fine-grained material than in coarse-grained material because
cohesion may allow cracking and separation of the soil away from the sheet
pile. Bearing value of steel sheet piling should be neglected.
All inland flood walls should be provided with a landb. Toe Drains.
side toe drain similar to that shown in Figure 7-2.
Coastal flood walls
should be analyzed to determine if such drains are needed. The toe drain,
which runs parallel to the wall at the landside edge of the footing, provides
a positive outlet for local underseepage and a check for controlling piping
and/or excessive uplift pressure beneath the base slab. For walls on impervious foundations, the toe drain may be adequate to control all underseepage; for
walls on pervious foundations, additional seepage control measures will
7-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
\J
A'
""
~----1Lr-....L-..J-_,__---
--
Cutoff - - - - - - t
Datum
6l
0.0
Total head at B
= EIA'
= E1 0 + [
Pressure head at C
Figure 7-3.
DC
DCB' ] < EIA.- E1 0 l
= Total
head at C - El c
7-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
usually be required. In the case of pile-founded walls, the toe drain should
be adequate to protect against "roofing," the loss of material from beneath the
wall base. The drain should never be located under the wall footing, in order
to allow maintenance access and to avoid crushing the drain. A typical toe
drain design will consist of a 6- to 8-inch-diameter pipe perforated on the
bottom half and surrounded in all directions with 6 to 10 inches of filter
material designed by the filter criteria in paragraph 6-6e. The collected
water is usually disposed of by gravity outlets into ditches, ponding areas, or
pump stations. The toe drain system should provide access for inspection and
maintenance at changes in alignment and at intervals not to exceed 500 feet.
Discharge pipes should be provided with check valves that will prevent the
entrance of surface water.
c. Trench Drains. Where the impervious top stratum is thin or nonexistent, a trench drain may be used to control underseepage in the vicinity of
the flood wall toe. A trench drain is an enlarged variation of a toe drain.
It extends from the ground surface through shallow pervious layers or into a
pervious layer underlying a shallow surface blanket. The practical depth for
construction of a trench drain depends on available excavation equipment and
site dewatering requirements. The excavation, pipe placement, and backfilling
of the trench should always be performed in the dry. To assure adequate
capacity, the collector pipe should be sized considerably larger than computations indicate to be necessary. Backfill in a trench drain should conform to
the filter criteria in paragraph 6-6e. A trench drain should be provided with
inspection and maintenance access and backflow protection as described for toe
drains. The seepage calculations for the quantity of flow should assume the
tailwater elevation equal to that of the discharge of the trench drain.
However, if water can pond on the landside of the wall, the calculations for
uplift pressure should check whether a more critical uplift condition can occur
for the ponded case.
d. Relief Wells. Pressure relief wells are used to reduce uplift pressures at depths in pervious layers which might otherwise cause sand boils and
piping of foundation materials. Wells function to some extent as a controlled
sand boil, relieving pressure by discharging water, but retaining materials
with a screen and filter. Wells are advantageous where pervious strata are
relatively thick or relatively deep. They are particularly useful in controlling large quantities of seepage in strata of pervious material having
direct connections with the river. Another advantage of relief wells is the
ease with which they can be constructed if piezometric pressures measured
during high water indicate the need for additional underseepage control.
Design of relief well systems is described in EM 1110-2-1905, EM 1110-2-1901,
and WES Technical Memorandum 3-424 (US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment
Station, 1956). The design entails selecting a spacing, size, and penetration
for a line of wells that will result in acceptable gradients at points midway
between the line of wells and at the flood wall toe. Relief wells are usually
not very effective in intercepting near-surface seepage, and it is often wise
to use them in combination with a toe drain. Relief wells should be pumptested when installed. Because the efficiency of relief wells may deteriorate
with time due to corrosion or bacterial incrustation, considerable monitoring
7-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
and maintenance may be required to assure that the relief well system performs
acceptably for the project life. To assess possible well deterioration, a
representative number of wells should be periodically pump-tested, and the
specific capacity (flow/drawdown) should be compared to the initial pump test
results. To calculate uplift pressures on the wall, the potential head at the
well line should be assumed equal to the average head in the plane of wells, a
value obtained as part of the well design procedure in the cited references.
e. Riverside Impervious Blankets. Impervious riverside blankets (natural
or constructed) overlying a pervious foundation are effective in reducing the
quantity of seepage and to some extent are effective in reducing uplift
pressures and gradients landside of the flood wall. Their effects may be
analyzed using seepage analysis methods found in EM 1110-2-1913 and WES
Technical Memorandum 3-424 (US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station,
1956). Riverside blankets may be constructed over thin natural impervious
blankets to improve the effects of the natural blankets or they may be constructed directly on pervious material. Excessively steep riverbanks may make
blanket construction impractical. Also, it is seldom feasible to construct
blankets over exposed portions of the pervious layer under water. A noncontinuous blanket has serious drawbacks, as only a small area of pervious stratum
left exposed may significantly reduce the blankets effectiveness. Riverside
impervious blankets need to overlap the riverside base of the flood wall to
minimize the potential for rupture of the blanket by landward deflection of the
flood wall when loaded. Riverside impervious blankets may be subject to scour
at high river stages when they would be most needed, or may crack open if not
continuously wet. To prevent such action, blankets should be protected immediately after construction. A well-designed and well-planted vegetative cover
is ordinarily sufficient along straight reaches. Along outside curves of the
river, the blankets should be protected with riprap or other positive
protection.
f. Landside Seepage Berms. Landside seepage berms function by providing
an increased landside top blanket thickness, thereby reducing the gradient.
The berm also extends the seepage path by forcing the seepage exit landward.
Seepage berms are typically 100 to 300 feet wide. As flood walls are usually
built in areas where right-of-way cost or availability is insufficient for
levee construction, seepage berms are rarely used in conjunction with flood
walls. Procedures for seepage berm design are presented in WES Technical
Memorandum 3-424 (US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, 1956) and
EM 1110-2-1913.
g. Grouting of Open Rock Joints. In cases where rock is shallow enough
that flood walls can be founded directly on the rock, close examination of the
rock surface is necessary to determine if open joints are present. Such joints
can be detrimental to underseepage control and should be cleaned out and filled
with grout before the concrete base is placed. If the possibility exists for
seepage flow through porous or cavernous rock in the foundation, consideration
should be given to installing a grout curtain.
7-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Section III.
Foundation Considerations
7-5. Base Types. The T-wall is the most widely used flood wall type. T-walls
are normally constructed with horizontal or sloped bases. The advantages of
each type of base are as follows:
a.
(4) A full-size flood wall test performed by the Ohio River Division
(1948-1956) (U. S. Army Engineer Division, Ohio River 1958) indicated that the
sloped-base wall moved consistently less than the horizontal-base wall of
comparable design.
c. Selection. Both base types have their advantages and disadvantages.
Final selection will depend upon the specific site conditions at the project
under consideration.
7-6. Horizontal Water and Earth Loads on Keys. For flood walls on clay
foundations, full flood head will be conservatively assumed to act at the bottom of the key and the horizontal water load acting on the riverside face of
the key will be computed on this basis. The seepage path will then be assumed
to begin at the bottom of the key. The landside face of the key will normally
be assumed to be in full contact with the earth-resisting movement of the wall.
7-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 7-4.
be founded on piles through the unsuitable material. In some cases the removal
of unsuitable foundation material involves the removal of or cutting into the
existing riverbank on which the flood wall is to be placed. In other cases the
right-of-way may be so restricted and confining that the flood wall may have to
be placed near the top edge of the bank or even riverward of the bank. In
those cases, fill placed riverward of the top bank is permitted, if proper
precautionary measures are taken. Careful attention must be paid to the
outlining of and removal of unsatisfactory material and to the selection of
suitable replacement material. New material must be obtained, placed, and
compacted to provide adequate support for the flood wall. Replacement material
should undergo the same types of laboratory testing as existing foundation
material. Placement and compaction techniques should generally be in
accordance with earth dam and levee requirements. Slopes steeper than 1.0V on
1.5H and areas that require hand compaction should be minimized. Slopes on
which there is evidence of past instability, or in which fill is a component,
7-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-~
7-12
Unsuitable Material
Pourous, Fill Cinders!
Replace with Suitabl
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - " ' - - - + l - Material
Zone 1
Zone 1
Sheet Pile
Cutoff (Optional)
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
should be investigated for stability. All riverward slopes should be checked
for stability if the failure of the bank would jeopardize the stability of the
wall.
7-8. Scour Protection. Occasionally a flood wall is exposed to scouring
because of the direction, curvature, and velocity of current or waves, characteristics of the soil, topography, etc. Scouring at the wall footing should be
considered, and where anticipated, protected with riprap. Design guidance on
sizing riprap is given in EM 1110-2-1601.
Section IV.
Types of Monoliths
a. Junctures.
A junction between a T-wall and levee is not made
directly or abruptly, but with a short transition concrete-capped sheet piling
I-wall between the two (Figures 7-7 and 7-8). One of the primary concepts in
the development of this transition is to arrange details so there will be a
minimum amount of differential movement of joints of monoliths in the transition. The levee end of the transition will usually settle a considerable
amount, due primarily to foundation consolidation under the added weight of
the levee. The T-wall monolith immediately adjacent to the beginning of the
levee adds far less superimposed weight on the foundation. Hence, there is
much less settlement at this end of the transition. The I-wall can be satisfactorily adopted as a transition section between levee and T-wall because
this type of construction can, and in fact must, be done after completion of
the levee. A delay in inserting the I-wall allows for settling of the levee,
7-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
WATER SIDE
LAND SIDE
Re-entrant
monolith
PLAN
WATER SIDE
Rein forcem en t
continuous
across
contraction
joint.
Keys
Stem
Joint filler
Re-entrant monolith
Toe
LAND SIDE
PLAN
Expansion joint material (paragraph 7-:-14a) to be
used where each end of re-entrant monolith
touches the adjacent monoliths (see Figure 7-9a).
Figure 7-6.
7-14
1-Wall (concrete
cap and sheet
piling)
Levee
T-Wall
of embankment
------ Start 1- Wall where h
becomes B' to 10'
Top of embankment
1o max. height of
pile cantilever.
Bottom of
concrete
cap _ _____/
Max. elevation of
lower end of piling _ _ _ ___/
Ground line
back to stem
Bottom of adjacent key
7-15
T-WALL -
I-WALL -
LEVEE TRANSITION
Levee
I -
Wall
Concrete ca
and
--Top of embankment
Top of embankment
--1
ELEVATION
WALL -
Figure 7-7.
LEVEE TRANSITION
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
h = B' or 10'
max. cantilever
r -----.,-----
1'-6'
-~----~~-~
IY2 "
holes to be
burned in field. ----,
__J
u
~
I
I
.--t- River faqe of wall
I
snu~
1/)
.'!'
L
7-16
Sheet piling
2!/z" CL
I
I
I
><
--
\-f- Top
---
of wall toe
SECTION A-A
Note:
For location of section A-A,
Bee Figure 7-7.
Figure 7-8,
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Return key
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
thus lessening the differential settlement between the levee end of the
transition and the T-wall. Review by hydraulic engineers is required for
inland flood walls to assure that the transition geometry will not create significant flow disturbance with consequent scour.
b. I-wall. The I-wall portion of the transition is begun where the levee
slope (parallel to the protection) reaches a point 10 feet below the top of the
wall. In cases where protection is already 10 feet or less above the levee, an
I-wall, if used, is merely continued into the levee as shown in Figure 7-7.
c. Sheet Piling. It should be noted in Figure 7-7 that the sheet piling
is continued into the levee for a specified distance beyond the last concrete
cap.
Section V.
7-13. Water Stops. As shown in Figure 7-9a, b, and c, for yielding foundations a U-shaped (type "U") water stop should enclose almost the entire base
and a center bulb (type "Y") water stop, located in the stem, is joined to the
U-shaped water stop at the bottom of the stem. Experience has shown that a
center bulb or dumbbell water stop located within the base section is likely to
allow excessive seepage. Between monoliths on a foundation requiring a cutoff,
the type Y water stop in the stem should be extended to tie into the cutoff,
and the type U water stop around the base should be deleted. The earth surface
on which a type U water stop is installed must be firm and smooth, with no
chips, sags, humps, clods, or loose debris that would prevent intimate contact
between the water stop and soil. See Chapter 6, paragraph 6-4e, for general
guidance on water stops. Because field construction problems are common for
the type "A" joints shown in Figure 7-9a with the type U water stop shown in
Figure 7-9b, and because the buried base slab does not experience wide
temperature changes, an optional base slab joint is allowed when the base is
placed. This base slab joint uses construction joints without water stops but
with the base slab longitudinal reinforcement continuous through the joint.
When this option is used, longitudinal reinforcement of at least 0.4 percent of
the slab cross-sectional area must be provided in the base slab, half in each
face, but with not more than #9 reinforcing bars at 12-inch spacings in each
face.
7-14. Contraction and Expansion Joints. Contraction and expansion joint
details are illustrated in Figures 7-9a through 7-9c. Contraction joints
(type A) should contain a bond-breaker. Expansion joints (type "B") should
contain 1/2-inch preformed expansion joint filler in:
a. All protruding (convex on water side) monolith bases, and in selected
reentrant monolith bases and stems as shown in Figure 7-6.
b. In bases and stems of alternate monolith joints in straight-line runs,
if warranted by previous experience with similar foundation conditions.
7-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
See Detoll'A"
Type y
Woterstop
--------~
River side
of wall
<p-
sz
Bond breaker as
r-equired. !See
Section A-A and
q>-
Type y
~ai"erstop
Const. Jt.:
Transition
(See detail
on Figure 7-9c
DETAIL A
Const.Jt.
Type
\!later stop
Type y
waters-top
JoinT
sealer
TYPICAL SECTION
Type 'Y'
waters top
River face
of wall
,.
...
\12" premou!ded
expansion Joint
material.
Make joinT I"
thick at change
of direcTion
sTems
Contraction joints.
bond breaker----~~---Y
SECTION A-A
\lz" premoulded
--,.&-J expansion Joint
"" ma-terial
.."
Contraction join-ts.
bond breaker -----+-----~
.>--+--Type u
woterstop
~LITH
SECTION B-B
a.
Figure 7-9.
7-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~--River
face of wall
1'-6"
Type u
water stop
Varies
I - l l - - - Type y rubber
water stop
1'-6"
Varies
tO
2
L
>
Type u rubber
waterstop ---~~
SECTION C-C
1'-6"
Detail 'I'____../\, _ /
SECTION 0-D
l'-6"
1'-6"
1'-6"
Type u
water stop
Detall 'I'
Low
II)
>
Type u
wa-ter stop
SECTION E-E
bose wall
wall
Type u
waters top-+:.__.:....,
DETAIL 'I'
Type u rubber
water stop
PLAN
(Sheet 2 of 3)
7-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
9"
Type 'Y'
/ti" R. CTYPl
TYPE sym
/4'R
'
II
11
--I~2
c.
Figure 7-9.
(Sheet 3 of 3)
7-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c. In bases and stems of junctures of walls with gate wells, pump
stations, gate abutments, and similar structures. Nonflexible material in a
protruding angle joint is particularly dangerous.
d.
Site Considerations
7-15. Adjacent Structures and Rights-of-Way. Flood walls are usually built
because only a narrow right-of-way is available. The presence of existing
buildings or other structures is usually the reason for a narrow right-of-way.
Sewer pipes with open joints, structures with basements, and excavations close
to the wall may create a hazard to the safety of a flood wall. Also, new
structures that are built close to existing flood walls can create the same
hazards. Present right-of-way acquisition policies do not permit legal restrictions to be placed on future construction; however, local interests
should be advised in writing of potential hazards, of required design and construction measures, and should be requested to closely supervise new construction close to the flood wall. Potential hazards can be avoided by proper
design and construction measures. One hazard that should be considered is
seepage. A basement or other excavation on the landside of the flood wall may
result in shortened seepage paths. A basement or excavation on the riverside
may also create a safety hazard if it penetrates the impervious blanket or
shortens the seepage path.
When feasible, the basement or excavation should
be backfilled with the same type of material existing in the foundation of the
flood wall. If relief wells are selected to control seepage they should be
located, if at all possible, between the flood wall toe and the adjacent
structure. Protection of the basement area may require lowering of discharge
elevations for safeguarding the wall. The location of relief wells within a
basement area is not prohibited, but it leads to problems of construction,
maintenance, and discharge collection. If the seepage problem is only one of
quantity, sump pumping may be used during periods of high water. A second
hazard that landside basements and excavations create is to lessen the resistance to sliding along a foundation failure plane. For this reason potential
planes of sliding into basements or excavations should be studied. If backfilling is not possible, other measures include the addition of fill between
the stem and the building or strengthening the basement to provide the needed
resistance. Riverside excavations which contribute to riverward foundation
instability should be backfilled, at least to the extent that stability
requirements will be satisfied. For the special situation where a wall in a
congested location is subjected to an unusually large horizontal force, such
as the force of a breaking wave, T-type flood walls are frequently worth the
extra cost over other types of construction. This situation requires an
unusually wide base for sliding stability, requiring more right-of-way and,
hence, more cost for construction. The relatively thin stem of the T-wall
does, however, provide the most usable surface area adjacent to the stem after
backfilling, in comparison with embankment, braced walls, etc., making the
T-wall the preferred solution in spite of the extra construction easement
right-of-way. While an I-wall also provides little intrusion on the completed
7-21
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
surface area, its use can be precluded by the pile-driving vibration and consequent chance of damage to adjacent structures.
7-16. Architectural and Landscaping Considerations. Aesthetics should be considered in the design of flood walls, from the standpoint of blending the
project with the surroundings. Whenever possible, the wall should appear to be
a natural extension of the local topography. The basic design of these
structures should be a coordinated effort between the design engineer, the
architect, and the landscape architect. While it is seldom feasible to preserve the natural setting intact, design techniques and careful construction
methods can be used to protect or even enhance the aesthetic value of the
immediate project area. Landscape planting design for project structures
should consider the entire area affected by the contemplated construction.
Further details may be found in EM 1110-1-2009 and EM 1110-2-301.
Section VII.
Instrumentation
7-22
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
certain, previously selected, critical locations during design flood stages.
During normal water stages, instruments should be read prior to district
periodic inspections so that the inspection party has the necessary evaluation
data. Such data also provide a history of flood wall reactions over the years,
during both high and normal water. Information concerning frequency and manner
of conducting periodic inspections and evaluations is contained in
ER 1110-2-100, while ER 1130-2-339 covers local flood protection projects.
7-18. Types of Instrumentation. The principal types of flood wall instrumentation monitor movements, both vertical and horizontal, and hydrostatic pressures in the foundation. The instruments selected should be simple to install
and observe, and efficient in performance and functional reliability. The
monitoring of the movements provides an indication of possible sliding instability or possible water stop rupture. The piezometers provide a record of
hydrostatic pressures in the foundation which can indicate uplift and possible
excessive seepage pressures. Instrumentation systems, installations, and
devices are discussed in detail in EM 1110-2-4300.
a. Movement Monitoring. All reference points to monitor movements should
be tied in to a permanent baseline located so that it is unaffected by
movements of the wall. When establishment of a baseline is not feasible, the
relative movements observed between monoliths or by means of triangulation can
provide valuable data on behavior of the wall. Reference points to monitor the
wall movements need to be installed during construction. Noncorrosive metal
plugs should be installed in the top surfaces of the stems within 6 inches of
each end of each monolith. The reference marks in the plugs of four to six
successive monoliths should be placed in a straight line with theodolite or
stretched wire. At changes in alignment, the straight line should be continued
until it intersects the far side of the next monolith and a reference point for
alignment control is placed. Each plugs changes in horizontal movement and
elevation should be measured to 0.001 foot. Stations to be read with
electronic optical reading devices need to be established at locations near the
ground surface level on the landside of the stem. Selection of
electronic-optical station locations for the stem should be based on factors
such as changes of direction, areas of overbank fill, foundation replacement,
high walls, low embedment ratios, and junctures of flood walls with drainage
structures. The monitoring system selected should be vandalproof. In many
cases the monitoring system can be tied into the same baselines established for
the reference markers on top of the wall. Tilting of stems can be measured by
a tiltmeter.
b. Foundation Piezometers. Design, installation, and observations of
piezometers are described in EM 1110-2-1908, Part I. The simplest, most
reliable method of measuring pore water pressures is the open tube piezometer.
For impervious soils, the Casagrande type of piezometer with 24-inch-long
porous stone is recommended. In order to measure the piezometric pressure at
the porous tip, the boring for installation of the Casagrande piezometer must
be effectively sealed against migration of seepage along the piezometer riser.
For semipervious to pervious soils, a driven wellpoint type of piezometer is
recommended. Where possible, the wellpoint should be driven into undersized,
7-23
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
pre-bored holes.
warrant.
Section VIII.
7-19. General Coverage. General coverage of the requirements of local cooperation is contained in EM 1120-2-109. As written, the regulations are general
in nature and obviously cannot give detailed instructions for the maintenance
and operation of a specific project. Therefore, it is necessary for the
district office having jurisdiction over the specific project to issue an
adequate operation and maintenance manual for the guidance of local interests.
Section IX.
7-24
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
monoliths at changes in alignment is likely to force excessive flexure in the
stem, sufficient to cause failure. The same tilting can occur at reentrant
monoliths (Figure 7-6), but there the tilting is landward and the reinforcing
is more adequate to resist the stress. For angle monoliths protruding toward
the river, the landside temperature steel can be quickly overstressed.
d. Water Stops. Joints with torn or parted water stops should be considered critical. Torn water stops may not be noticed during an inspection,
particularly if the joint has not spread open. If sufficient differential
movement has occurred, it should be assumed that the water stop is torn. The
amount of tearing to be allowed should be based on factors causing piping;
however, this is very difficult to predict. In the above cases, if a total
differential movement (transverse and longitudinal combined) of 1/2 inch or
more has occurred, the water stop should be considered torn unless shown
otherwise.
e. Foundation Voids. All unequal settlements should be viewed with
suspicion. In particular, unequal settlements adjacent to structures such as
pump houses and gate wells should be the subject of rigid examination. Usually
one or two monoliths (or a portion of one monolith) are constructed on
compacted fill in these areas. Initial unequal settlement may cause the first
monolith to bridge or wedge between the second monolith and the other structure. Further consolidation of the fill then leaves a dangerous void or voids
under this base. Only underground examination will reveal the presence of
these voids.
f. Stability Analyses. Original seepage assumptions or patterns should
be reviewed for realistic representation of actual foundation conditions.
Particular attention should be paid to foundations having pervious strata which
connect directly with the river. Where indicated, seepage and/or stability
analyses should be recomputed as described in Chapters 3, 4, and 5. In
addition to a recomputation of uplift, the shear strengths used in the original
analyses should be reevaluated on the basis of a study of types of soil and
their drainage and consolidation characteristics. In cases where there is a
lack of sufficient foundation information in areas suspected to be weak, new
soil samples should be obtained as close to the existing wall as is feasible.
Areas found to have questionable stability should be closely observed during
high floods.
g. Basements and Other Excavations. The seepage aspects and the foundation stability of walls which have had basements excavated on either side of
and adjacent to the wall since the original design and construction were
completed should be investigated.
h. Seepage Conditions Landside of Flood Walls. These areas should be
investigated thoroughly and seepage control of pressure relief provided, if
needed.
7-25
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
7-21.
Repair Measures.
7-26
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 7-10.
7-27
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
%'dowels
12"
llfa'\11
Type u
woterstop _
DETAIL '2'
__...,~
2h
-f
[oter
side of
I
Sheet
<f1
existing Key
'
Type u
woterstop~
Type 'Y'
waters top---<!>!
NOTE:
PLAN
Section B-B Varies Varies
Section A-A
1'-6'
3'-0'
I' -6"
1'-6'
::0
'
f---'"--,---,-l..:.j--<1,--lJI.-~!.-_.l....J-..JI.--'
Sheet
piling
River face
existing wail,
top of base slab
or face of key
Woterstop
Existing waterstop
& expansion joint
\ __ Detoil'2'
SECTION C-C
a.
Figure 7-11.
7-28
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
---~
Flllwl1"h
bituminous
cement
Top of
existing
wall
'Y"rubber----~
water stop
Sand blast
hammer existing
Type y
woterstop ---lt----<"i!
9'
9' 6'
River face of
existing wall ---tl--+--""1
'
I
_,
iEI
I
_u_-~v-~-
Sand blast
or bush hammer
existing surface
3'-0'
1: ~-6
Type u
water stop
Sheet
~ ~-6 :1
I
See Detoii'A'
11
piling~
Top of
base slab
1'-6'
1
h' expansion
joint
Top of
sheet
pile
Exisi"lng
expansion
Top of "'"
warles
SECTION D-0
Web of
Type y
Type y
water stop
2' min.
plug with
soft rubber
or rubber
cement
:..
1\
Notes for DETAIL 'A'
%"x2Y2'x81h'
rubber
Figure 7-11.
L_
DETAIL 'A'
%'x2Yz"x6'
rubber
Type u
water stop
NOTES:
1. For details of y & u type
rubber waterstop,see FIGURE 7-9C
2. All steel In blisters 2' clear.
3. For Section c-c, see FIGURE 7-IIA
4. for Section D-0 location.
see FIGURE 7-IIA
(Concluded)
7-29
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 8
CONCRETE GRAVITY WALLS
8-1. General Factors. Factors favoring concrete gravity retaining walls are
shallow depth of overburden, a competent foundation, and an adequate source of
fine and coarse aggregate for the required volume of concrete. See Chapter 2,
Section I for additional comments on gravity walls.
8-2. Foundation Investigation. The requirements for the foundation investigation are discussed in Chapter 2, Section V.
8-3. Materials. A concrete compressive strength of 2,000 to 2,500 psi will
usually meet the requirements for the gravity type wall. Where the environment
requires durability, such at as the outer surface of the wall, the higher
strength should be achieved with the appropriate water-cement ratio from
EM 1110-2-2000.
8-4.
Design.
a.
8-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c. External Stability. Sliding and overturning stability should be
determined by the methods and criteria discussed in Chapter 4. Computer
program 3DSAD will significantly assist in performing stability analyses. An
example of a complete stability analysis of a gravity wall section is shown in
example 2 of Appendix N.
d. Internal Stability. The resultant of all forces acting on any horizontal section should fall within the kern or sufficiently close to the kern of
the section to keep the tensile stresses low. See EM 1110-1-2101 for allowable
concrete stresses.
e. Foundation Analyses. Foundation analyses should be performed in
accordance with the methods described in Chapters 4 and 5.
8-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 9
CANTILEVER REINFORCED CONCRETE WALLS
9-1. General Characteristics. The cantilever reinforced concrete wall is a
special type of gravity wall in which part of the stabilizing weight is supplied by the weight of the backfill resting on the base slab. The structural
members are designed for stresses due to bending and shear. Chapter 2, Section I, offers additional general comments on cantilever concrete walls.
9-2. Foundation Investigation. The requirements for the foundation investigation are discussed in Chapter 2, Section V.
9-3. Materials. Concrete materials and mixture proportioning, with appropriate water-cement ratios for durability, should follow guide specification
CW 03301 and EM 1110-2-2000. Typically, a concrete compressive strength of
3,000 psi is used for retaining walls. The age at which the specified strength
is to be obtained should be decided by the designer depending on the loading
conditions anticipated. Steel reinforcement bars should follow the
specifications in the American Concrete Institute (ACI) Building Code
(ACI 318), with the exception that for hydraulic structures the grade of steel
will be limited to ASTM Grade 60 without special approval.
9-4. Reinforcement Cover. For hydraulic structures the minimum reinforcement
cover should comply with EM 1110-2-2103. For structures not subject to
hydraulic action the minimum reinforcement cover should comply with the ACI
Building Code requirements.
9-5. Load Cases. The load cases should be those described in Section I of
Chapter 4. The magnitude and distribution of the loads should be determined as
described in Chapter 3.
9-6. Structural Stability. Sliding and overturning stability should be
determined by the methods and criteria discussed in Chapter 4. Forces and
moments for structural design should be based on external forces allocated
according to paragraphs 3-7 through 3-9 and calculated as described in
Section III of Chapter 4 for overturning stability. Sample stability
calculations are shown in Appendix N.
9-7.
Structural Design.
9-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 9-1.
b.
Stem.
c. Toe. The toe should be designed with loads imposed by soil, water,
concrete, bearing pressures, etc. The effects of axial loads are not ordinarily substantial enough to be taken into account.
d. Heel. The loads for calculating design moments are the weight of
soil, water, and concrete acting downward, along with uplift and bearing pressure acting upward. The bearing pressure should be determined using the horizontal earth force and shear when the backfill surface is sloping upward (see
paragraphs 9-7a and 4-8c). With no key, the base shear should be neglected
when computing reinforcement, as illustrated in Appendix N, example 1.
e. Special Considerations for Walls with Keys. The overturning stability
criteria for walls with keys include an assumed uniform distribution of earth
pressure on the resisting side of the key that may result in unconservative
design for reinforcement in the top face of the wall heel at and near the face
of the stem. A portion of this force may actually act along the plane at the
base slab of the wall and not on the key. The designer is cautioned to
consider this in developing a reinforcing design. A conservative approach for
design of the heel top steel at the stem would result from the use of foundation pressures obtained from a stability analysis assuming that all of the
earth resistance acts along the plane at the base of the wall. See Section III
of Chapter 4, especially paragraph 4-8b. Stability calculations for walls with
keys are shown in examples 3 and 6 of Appendix N.
9-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
9-8.
or
where
D =
internal forces and moments from dead load of the concrete members
only
L =
internal forces and moments from live loads (loads other than the
dead load of concrete members)
(b) For unusual or extreme loading conditions such as cases R2, R3, I2,
I3, I4, C2b, C3, C4, and C5, earthquakes, and short-term loadings:
or
9-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(c) In most retaining walls and flood walls, dead loads represent a small
percentage of total loads and the additional effort to recompute another
stability analysis using the above two factors may not be warranted. Therefore, a single load factor as defined by Equation 9-5 may be substituted for
Equations 9-1 and 9-2 to avoid having to recompute an alternate stability
analysis with a different set of loadings. Likewise, Equation 9-6 may be substituted for Equations 9-3 and 9-4.
is modified so that
D =
L =
all loads other than dead load of concrete, or related axial forces,
shears, and moments
(d) When multiple load factors are used and the reactions (i.e., base
reactions, pile reactions, resisting earth pressures, etc.) are computed using
the applied factored loads, the following combinations should be considered:
where R
equals internal forces and moments resulting from reactions induced
f
by the applied factored dead and live loads.
(e) When the single load factor is used and the reactions (i.e., base
reactions, pile reactions, resisting earth pressures, etc.) are computed using
the applied unfactored loads, the following combinations should be considered:
(See paragraphs j and k, Example 1, Appendix N).
9-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
[9-12]
where R equals internal forces and moments resulting from reactions induced
by applied unfactored dead and live loads.
(2) Design Strength of Reinforcement. The design should be based on
yield strengths of reinforcement of 40,000 psi and 48,000 psi for ASTM
Grades 40 and 60 steels, respectively, except for calculating development
lengths. The development length for Grades 40 and 60 steels should be based on
yield strengths of 40,000 psi and 60,000 psi, respectively. Reinforcement with
a yield strength in excess of Grade 60 should not be used unless a detailed
investigation of ductility and serviceability requirements is conducted in
consultation with and approved by Headquarters, US Army Corps of Engineers
(HQUSACE) (CECW-ED).
(3) Maximum Tension Reinforcement. For flexural members and for members
subject to combined flexure and compressive axial load when the design load
strength P
is less than the smaller of 0.10f A
or P , the ratio of
n
c g
b
tension reinforcement provided generally should not exceed 0.25 . Reinb
forcement ratios greater than 0.25
but less than 0.50
may be used in
b
b
retaining walls if excessive deflections are not predicted when using the
method specified in the ACI Building Code. Reinforcement ratios in excess of
0.50
should not be used unless a detailed investigation of serviceability
b
requirements, including computation of deflections, is conducted in consultation with and approved by HQUSACE (CECW-ED).
(4) Minimum Reinforcement of Flexural Members. At any section of a
flexural member where reinforcement is required by analysis, the minimum reinforcement requirements specified in the ACI Building Code, should apply, except
that f
should be in accordance with paragraph 9-8b(2).
y
(5) Control of Deflections and Cracking. Cracking and deflections due to
service loads need not be investigated if the limits on design strength
specified in paragraph 9-8b(2) and a reinforcement ratio of 0.25
are not
b
exceeded. Where these limitations are exceeded, extensive investigation of
deformation and cracking due to service loads should be made in consultation
with higher authority.
(6) Distribution of Flexural Reinforcement. The spacing of flexural
tension reinforcement should not generally exceed 18 inches for Grade 40 steel,
or 12 inches for Grade 60 steel.
(7) Extreme Loadings. For extreme loadings which are highly improbable,
such as from earthquakes which have a frequency of occurrence that greatly
exceeds the economic life of the structure, selection of less conservative
load factors than given in Equations 9-3, 9-4, and 9-6 and less conservative
9-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
strength criteria than given above may be justified. For extreme loadings,
requests and the justification for varying from the guidance should be submitted to HQUSACE (CECW-E) for approval.
c.
(1)
Design Assumptions.
(a) Strain. The assumed maximum usable strain at the extreme concrete
compression fiber should be equal to 0.003. The design strain
at the
m
extreme concrete compression fiber should be limited to 0.5 of the maximum
usable strain for hydraulic structures.
(b) Balanced Conditions. Balanced conditions exist at a cross section
when the tension reinforcement reaches the strain corresponding to its specified yield strength f
just as the concrete in compression reaches its
y
design strain . T-wall members should be designed for a ductile failure
m
on the tensile side of balance, as described in paragraphs 9-7a, 9-8b(3),
and 9-8b(4).
(c)
Concrete Stress.
A concrete stress of
where
f
y max
, p
=
0.85f
max
b
c
9-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
r
h
t k~d
~,
(0.85f~
)Mu
( 1- ku )d
2
ku bd)
As
fy A5
DESIGN
GIVEN : Mu. b. d. h. fy f~ =0.9
FIND: ku As
k
u
= 1-
AND p
1Mu
0 A 2 5 f~ b d 2
As=
P =_&__<p
bd - MAX
0.85f~
ku bd
fy
0.85f~ ku
= ___
.:...___.=__
fy
PMAX
FIND: ku AND Mu
ku = fyP
0.85f~
Figure 9-2.
9-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
LOADING
DESIGN
GIVEN : Pu Mu, b, d. h. fy.f~.
(<I>
As AND p
FINO: ku.
ku=
1-\~~u~e___
0.85fc ku bd - (/)
As=------~----~
fy
0.425 <P f~ bd 2
0.85f2 ku fy
Pu
bd
INVESTIGATION
GIVEN : ~.b. d. h. fy. f~ .<P<SEE DESIGN).A 5
P~
PMAX
Pu
bd +f;y P
0.85f~
Mu = Mue -Pu (d - 2)
Figure 9-3.
9-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
.P<0.85f~
ku bdl
EQUIVALENT LOADING
h
FOR EOU I VALENT LOADING: Mu e =Mu- Pu (d- 2)
DESIGN
ku =
1-V ,_0.425Mue
r:p fc' bd
Oo85f~
Pu
bd
r:/>
fy
Pu
0.85f~ ku bd + cp
As=------~----~-
fy
<
PMAX
INVESTIGATION
= fyP-
k
U
Oo85f~
Mu = Mue +
Figure 9-4.
Pu
p bq
A-.
, Mue = [0 85f
. c' k u ( 1- ku
2 ) bd 2] 'f"
Pu (d-2)
Rectangular member, bending with axial tensile load, where
Mu/Pu (d - h/2)
9-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d'
cpfy As
#yAs
As
'1d'
!-
h--~&Pu
'
)Mue
d-.2-.::--:~=:::r----~~--1::==>~ - - Py ~
As
cl>fy
As
cpfy As
EQUIVALENT LOADING
LOADING
ft
h
Cd-2)
DESIGN
Pu
As
T - fyA's
A$ =
=--=--~.:-....fy
Mue_
cpfy (d-d')
INVESTIGATION
Gl VEN :
~ ,b~
FIND: Mue
Mu =
Pu
d;o h, fy ,
Mu AND
f~
f~,
q, =0.9, As AND
A~
<STRESS IN A$)
h
(d-2) -Mue
Pu
f5 - T A's
Figure 9-5.
fyAs
fs
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
and is 0.25 for hydraulic structures, compared to a value of 0.75 allowed
by the ACI Building Code. Equation 9-13 is valid only for flexure.
(b) Design aids that will provide essentially the same results as the
equations given in Figures 9-2 through 9-5 may be found in ACI publication
SP-17. These will be valid for hydraulic structures so long as does not
exceed 0.25 and the allowable capacity of the cross section is limited by
flexural tension. Computer program CSTR (X0066) can assist in the design or
investigation of strength of members in hydraulic structures (Appendix O).
d. Structures Not Subject to Hydraulic Action--Strength and Serviceability. The strength and serviceability requirements for structures not subject to hydraulic action should be in accordance with the current ACI Building
Code. Computer program CASTR (X0067) can assist in the design or investigation
of strength of members in walls not subject to hydraulic action (Appendix O).
e. Structures Not Subject to Hydraulic Action--Reinforced Concrete
Design. Limits on strain, reinforcement, and concrete stress should be in
accordance with the current ACI Building Code.
f.
Shear Strength.
be computed in accordance with the ACI Building Code requirements. For cantilever retaining walls the maximum factored shear force should be computed at a
distance d from the base of the stem for stem design, at a distance d from
the stem for toe design, at the face of the stem for heel design, and at the
top of the key for key design. Wherever an L-shaped wall without a toe is
used, the shear force should be computed at the base of the stem for stem
design and at the face of the stem for heel design.
9-9. Foundation Analyses. Foundation analysis should be performed in accordance with the methods described in Chapters 4 and 5 and illustrated in Appendix N. Concrete design should be for earth pressures corresponding to loading
conditions which produce maximum tension in the respective elements of the
foundation slab based on factored ultimate loads. The loading conditions corresponding to SMF = 2/3 should be considered as a minimum for single wedge
analysis. This does not preclude the use of any other rational method of
analysis that will produce an equivalent design.
9-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CHAPTER 10
ALTERNATE TYPES OF RETAINING WALLS
Section I.
Introduction
10-1. Classes of Retaining Walls. The four basic classes of retaining walls
are gravity, cantilever, anchored, and mechanically stabilized backfill.
Gravity walls rely on the weight of the wall system to resist overturning. The
cantilever wall is fully reinforced to resist applied moments and shears.
Anchored walls resist lateral forces primarily by the use of tieback anchors.
Mechanically stabilized backfill involves the inclusion of reinforcement in the
soil to form a coherent mass (Godfrey 1984, Mitchell, Villet, and DiMillio
1984, and Jones 1985).
10-2. Alternate Types of Retaining Walls. As discussed previously in Chapter 2, the most common types of retaining walls are gravity and cantilever
walls constructed of cast-in-place concrete. Recently, however, a number of
wall systems utilizing mechanically stabilized backfill as well as new types of
gravity walls have been developed (Godfrey 1984). This chapter briefly
describes mechanically stabilized backfill systems and precast concrete modular
systems. The mention of any specific wall system does not constitute an
endorsement or approval. Numerous wall systems are available and should be
considered when appropriate. This manual does not attempt to provide complete
design and/or construction procedures for the types of walls described in this
chapter. Normally, design and construction procedures are provided by the
manufacturer. However, the manufacturer normally provides only part of the
design. The design engineer must assure the overall adequacy of the design.
Section II.
10-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
wire mesh, inclusion of intermediate reinforcements between main reinforcement
layers at the face, and seeding of the exposed soil.
b. Basic Mechanisms and Behavior. The two primary mechanisms of stress
transfer between the reinforcement and soil are friction between plane contact
surface areas and passive soil-bearing resistance on reinforcement surfaces
oriented transverse to the direction of movement. Strip, sheet, and rod reinforcements transfer stresses to the soil by friction, while grid reinforcements
transfer stresses primarily by passive resistance. Geogrid reinforcements
develop both frictional and passive soil resistance.
c. Strip Reinforcement. With strip reinforcement, a mechanically stabilized backfill is created by placing strips in horizontal planes between
successive lifts of soil backfill. Reinforced earth, shown schematically in
Figure 10-1, is a strip reinforcement system.
d. Grid Reinforcement. Grid reinforcement systems are formed by placing
metallic or polymeric tensile resistant elements in horizontal planes in the
soil backfill. Retaining walls using bar-mesh reinforcement have been constructed by the California Department of Transportation, Hilfiker Retaining
Walls; VSL Corporation, and the Georgia State Highway Department (see Figures 10-2 and 10-3). Grid reinforcements are also made of polymer materials,
such as Tensar Geogrid (see Figure 10-4).
10-5. Advantages and Disadvantages. The advantages and disadvantages of
mechanically stabilized backfill systems are outlined below (Mitchell and
Villet 1986).
a.
Advantages.
10-2
REINFORCING ELEMENt
PANEL
CONNECTION
10-3
..
. ..
...
,.
...
,.
.~
'f
':
BACKFILL MATERIAL~
~
. .
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 10-1.
. ..
..
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 10-2.
10-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 10-3.
10-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure 10-4.
10-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
various shapes, textures, and colors to provision of vegetation at the exposed
face of the soil.
b.
Disadvantages.
10-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a. Mechanisms. The transfer of stress between soil and reinforcement is
by friction and/or passive soil resistance when the reinforcement is loaded in
tension. In many reinforcement systems both mechanisms are present, and the
relative contribution of each is indeterminate.
(1) Friction. The load transferred by friction per unit area of reinforcement depends on the interface characteristics of the soil and reinforcement, and on the normal stress between them, which in turn depends on the
stress-deformation behavior of the soil. This latter behavior is itself
stress-dependent. Therefore, the effective friction coefficient cannot be
estimated by analytical procedures. The results of experiments such as pullout
tests, direct shear tests between soil and reinforcements, and instrumented
model and full-scale tests, are often used to select friction coefficients.
The coefficient of friction is defined as the average mobilized shear stress
along the reinforcement divided by the normal stress from the overburden
pressure. Empirical data from pullout tests on strip reinforcements show a
decrease in this coefficient with depth regardless of the type of
reinforcement (smooth or ribbed). This occurs because the effective normal
stress is altered by the soil to reinforcement interaction. As shear strains
are imposed on a dense granular soil, the soil tends to dilate. If the tendency to dilate is partially restrained by boundary conditions, local confining
stresses will increase with the tendency to dilate decreasing as the confining
stress increases. Hence, the influence of dilatancy on friction coefficients
computed from pullout tests decreases with depth. Therefore, since the influence of dilatancy decreases with depth, the coefficient of friction also decreases with depth. Also, recent experience in construction with granular
soils of low uniformity coefficients** (less than 4) indicates a relatively low
friction coefficient (1.0) for these types of granular soils.
(2) Passive Soil Resistance. Passive soil resistance to pullout of
reinforcement develops against bearing surfaces which are normal to the direction of the pullout force. For grid reinforcing systems with the spacing of
cross bars parallel to the wall equal to or greater than 6 inches, the major
portion of the resistance (approximately 90 percent for bar mesh in a sandy
gravel) is obtained by passive soil resistance or bearing capacity on the front
face of elements oriented transverse to the pullout force direction.
(3) Strain Compatibility. Friction between the soil and a smooth reinforcement requires a small displacement of about 0.05 inch. Passive soil
______________________________________________________________________________
*
**
= coefficient of uniformity
60
10
10-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
resistance against surfaces normal to displacement requires relative soil-toreinforcement displacements as large as 4 inches for complete mobilization.
However, a significant portion (greater than 50 percent) of the maximum value
is mobilized at deflections of about 0.25 inch (Elias 1986). For bar mat grid
reinforcement systems, the small beneficial effects of friction are neglected
in view of possible strain incompatibility between frictional behavior and passive soil resistance.
b. Behavior. The distribution of lateral earth pressure within reinforced soil depends on the extensibility of the reinforcements, the construction methods used, and the type of reinforced structure. The active horizontal
stress state is used for systems which are able to undergo relatively large
lateral deformations, such as geotextiles. Higher lateral stresses, such as
at-rest pressures, are associated with less extensible reinforcements, e.g.,
steel strips, bar meshes, welded wire mesh, and relatively low confining
pressures, e.g., at shallow depths in the soil backfill where dilatancy is most
effective. Under low confining stresses a reinforcement system may fail by
pullout between the reinforcement and soil. Under high confining stresses the
same system may fail by breakage of the reinforcements.
10-8. Materials. As previously mentioned, the three basic components of
mechanically stabilized backfill systems are reinforcements, soil backfill, and
facing elements (Mitchell and Villet 1986).
a. Reinforcement. The reinforcements may be characterized by the type of
material (metallic and nonmetallic) and geometry (strips, grids, and sheets).
Important material properties for reinforcements are strength and stability
(low tendency to creep), high coefficient of friction with soil backfill, and
durability. Depending on the electrochemical properties of the soil backfill
and structure environment (marine or freshwater, presence of stray electrical
currents in the ground, etc.) galvanized zinc-coated steel, resin-bonded
epoxy-coated steel, or polymeric reinforcements are used. Polymeric
reinforcements are not subject to corrosion but do exhibit creep characteristics (decrease in strength with time at constant load and soil
temperature).
b. Soil Backfill. Most mechanically stabilized embankment systems have
used cohesionless soil backfill. However, since grid reinforcements have a
much greater pullout resistance than strip reinforcements, it is possible to
construct mechanically stabilized embankment systems using silty or clayey
material as backfill (Forsyth 1979 and Jackura 1984). The advantages of cohesionless soil backfill are that it is stable (will not creep), free-draining,
not susceptible to frost, and relatively noncorrosive to reinforcement. The
main disadvantage, where cohesionless soil has to be imported, is cost. The
main advantage of cohesive soils is availability and hence lower cost. The
disadvantages are long-term durability problems (corrosion and/or frost susceptibility) and distortion of the structure (due to creep of the soil backfill).
When cohesionless soil backfill is readily available it should be
used. When it is not readily available, the costs of importing cohesionless
10-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
soil backfill should be weighed against the potentially poorer performance of
using the lower-cost locally available cohesive soil backfill.
c. Facing Elements. Since facing elements play only a secondary structural role, a greater flexibility in choice of materials is available to meet
aesthetic requirements than is the case for conventional retaining walls. A
wide variety of materials, shapes, architectural finishes, and colors are
available for facing elements. Selecting among these depends on the function
of the structure, type of reinforcement, and aesthetics.
10-9. Design Considerations. The various engineering companies involved in a
project provide site-specific designs for their proprietary system. Mechanically stabilized embankment systems must be designed for both external and
internal stability. External stability is evaluated in a manner similar to a
conventional gravity retaining wall. Internal stability depends on there being
neither pullout nor breakage of the reinforcement (Mitchell and Villet 1986,
Collin 1986).
a. External Stability. The mechanically stabilized backfill system must
be stable against sliding along the base of the structure, overturning about
the toe of the wall, bearing capacity failure of the foundation soil, overall
slope stability, and differential settlement along the structure. For external
stability calculations the mechanically stabilized backfill system is assumed
to behave as a coherent block.
(1) Sliding Along the Base of the Structure. The mechanically stabilized
backfill system must be stable against sliding due to the lateral pressure of
the soil retained by the system. The minimum factor of safety against sliding
should be 1.5. Sliding considerations may govern the design for high
structures (greater than 30 feet) or structures with sloping backfills.
(2) Overturning About the Toe of the Wall. The mechanically stabilized
backfill system must be stable against overturning about the toe of the wall.
Since in reality the structure is flexible, it would probably never fail by
overturning. One hundred percent of the base should always be in contact with
the subgrade for all loading conditions (Elias 1986). Overturning considerations seldom govern the design of structures when the minimum reinforcement
length is 70 percent of the wall height.
(3) Bearing Capacity Failure and Settlement.
The mechanically stabilized backfill system must be stable against bearing capacity failure of the
foundation soil.
The minimum factor of safety against bearing capacity failure should be 2.0. This is lower than that used for conventional retaining
walls (see Table 4-1) because of the flexibility of the mechanically stabilized backfill system and its ability to function satisfactorily after experiencing large differential settlements. If the foundation does not meet
stability requirements, consideration should be given to ground improvement
techniques such as stone columns, vibroflotation, and dynamic compaction to
improve foundation stability.
The maximum allowable differential settlement
of mechanically stabilized backfill systems is limited by the longitudinal
10-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
deformability of the facing and the purpose of the structure. For precast
concrete panels, without built-in vertical joints,* the limiting tolerable
differential settlement is 1 foot per 100 feet of wall length.
(4) Overall Slope Stability. The mechanically stabilized backfill systems, retained soil, and foundation should be stable against slope failure.
All potential slip surfaces should be investigated including those passing
through the reinforcement and deep-seated sliding. The minimum factor of
safety for slope stability should be 1.5.
b. Internal Stability. The mechanically stabilized backfill system must
be stable against reinforcement pullout and reinforcement breaking.
(1) Reinforcement Pullout. In determining the reinforcement pullout
capacity, the effective length of reinforcement behind the theoretical failure
surface must be great enough to assure the transfer of stress from the reinforcement to the backfill soil without reinforcement pullout. The resistance
to pullout may be frictional (strip reinforcement), passive (bar mesh reinforcement), or frictional-passive (Geogrid). Using data from laboratory pullout tests at a maximum of 0.75 inch of deformation, the structure should be
designed with a minimum factor of safety against reinforcement pullout of 1.5
at each reinforcement level.
(2) Reinforcement Breaking. To assure a sufficient reinforcement breaking capacity, the effective cross-sectional area of the reinforcement (corrected for corrosion effects over the design life of the structure) must be
great enough to allow for the transfer of stress from the reinforcement to the
backfill soil without the reinforcement breaking. The design stress in the
reinforcement should be taken as 55 percent of the yield stress (Elias 1986).
(3) Durability of Reinforcements.
The durability of reinforcements,
over the design life of the structure, is an important design consideration.
Deterioration of polymeric reinforcements may occur due to abrasion during
construction and decrease in strength with time at constant load and soil
temperature. Corrosion of metallic reinforcement occurs due to exposure to
air, water, and chemicals in the soil backfill. Galvanized zinc-coated steel
(with a sacrificial thickness of steel added to give the required service life)
is often used for reinforcing mild to moderately corrosive soil backfill with
the following properties** (Frondistou-Yannas 1985).
Resistivity > 3,000 ohm-centimetres
pH 5-10
______________________________________________________________________________
*
**
10-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Chlorides < 200 parts per million
Sulfates < 1,000 parts per million
For mild to moderately corrosive soil backfills the corrosion loss rates are:
Galvanization 6 m/year for first 2 years
2.5 m/year for subsequent years
Steel 9 m/year after all zinc is lost
The use of aluminum and stainless steel reinforcement is not recommended as
several failures have occurred using these materials (McGee 1985). For structures exposed to marine environments, stray electrical currents in the ground,
or with soil backfill properties outside the electrochemical guidelines previously given, resin-bonded epoxy-coated metallic reinforcements or a conventional or precast concrete modular gravity wall should be used. A minimum
epoxy coating thickness of 18 mils is necessary to survive transportation and
installation, and to provide an acceptable level of design confidence. When
epoxy-coated metallic reinforcement is used, the soil backfill should consist
of rounded stone with a maximum particle size of 1 inch. For design purposes,
the life of the epoxy coating should be assumed to be the same as a galvanized
zinc coating of 2 oz/sq ft, or 30 years. A sacrificial thickness of steel
should be added to provide the epoxy-coated reinforcement an adequate factor of
safety at the design life of the structure (Frondistou-Yannas 1985, Jones
1985).
c. Drainage. Drainage measures must be considered for all mechanically
stabilized backfill systems to prevent saturation of the soil backfill and to
intercept surface flows containing aggressive elements such as deicing chemicals. When mechanically stabilized backfill systems support roadways which are
chemically deiced in the winter, an impervious membrane should be placed
between the pavement and the first row of metallic reinforcements to intercept
any surface flows containing aggressive chemicals.
10-10. Construction Considerations. The construction of mechanically stabilized embankment systems does not require specialized contractors, skilled
labor, or special equipment. Many of the components are prefabricated, providing ease of handling and forming and relatively quick construction. A small
crane is used to handle and erect precast concrete facing panels. Front end
loaders are used for loading dump trucks and spreading the soil backfill.
Vibratory rollers are used to compact the soil backfill while small handoperated compactors are used for compaction near the wall face. Preparation of
the construction area consists of clearing vegetation, debris, and other
deleterious material from the site. A concrete leveling pad, which is not a
structural member, is constructed to facilitate the erection of the concrete
panels. The first layer of soil backfill is placed and compacted and the
reinforcement is laid on the surface of the compacted fill and covered with
the next layer of fill. Construction equipment must not run on top of the
10-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
reinforcement. Concrete panels are battered to the inside to compensate for
the small outward movement to mobilize the resistance of the reinforcement.
Filler material (cork, styrofoam, neoprene, etc.) is used between all horizontal joints to provide a uniform bearing surface between adjacent panels. A
geotextile is placed over all joints on the fill side of the concrete panels to
prevent fines from migrating from behind the wall (Mitchell and Villet 1986).
10-11. Instrumentation and Monitoring. The history of mechanically stabilized
embankment systems is relatively short compared to the design life of the
structure.* Therefore, continued accumulation of field data on a full-scale
structure is necessary to verify design assumptions. Structures should be
instrumented and monitored whenever atypical conditions exist such as cohesive
soil backfill, epoxy-coated metallic reinforcement, or adverse groundwater
conditions (outside the range specified in paragraph 10-9b(3)). Measurements
should be made of horizontal and vertical displacements of the wall facing;
soil pressures on the facing or on a vertical plane near the facing, the base
of the wall, and perpendicular planes (horizontal and vertical) along the
anticipated maximum tensile force line; tensile forces in the reinforcement
including near the locus of maximum tensile force and near the wall facing; and
pullout tests on short reinforcements. All mechanically stabilized embankment
structures should be monitored once they are placed in operation to ensure
stability. External stability of the mechanically stabilized embankment
structure could be threatened by the same factors as a conventional retaining
wall; e.g., clogging of the drainage system, erosion at the toe of the wall,
etc. However, the mechanically stabilized embankment system could also fail
due to changes in conditions which adversely influence the internal stability
of the system. These include excavation within the soil backfill, changes in
the groundwater conditions (outside the range specified in paragraph 10-9b(3)),
and possible damage to the stabilizing ties because of vandalism to the exposed
structure (Mitchell and Villet 1986, Al-Hussani and Perry 1978).
10-12. Maintenance and Repair. Since mechanically stabilized embankment
systems are relatively new there is very limited field experience regarding
maintenance and repair. Maintenance problems arising with facing elements
could be repaired by conventional methods since the facing elements play a
secondary role and resist only small horizontal earth pressures (Long et al.
1984). However, problems with the reinforcements, such as corrosion of
metallic reinforcements, would be difficult to repair. One possible solution
would be to use soil nailing to stabilize the structure (Jones 1985). Another
method would be to place a stone buttress in front of the structure (Mitchell
and Villet 1986).
10-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Section III.
Advantages.
(1) Modular systems are economical when compared to conventional retaining walls in cut situations, particularly where the retaining wall has a total
surface area greater than 500 sq ft and average wall heights greater than
8 feet.
(2) Assembly of the wall components requires no fasteners and the modules
may be reused easily and economically.
(3) The precast concrete modular retaining wall does not utilize reinforcing elements and therefore is not subject to corrosion damage.
(4) Excavation behind the precast concrete modular retaining wall does
not adversely influence the stability of the system as might occur for the
mechanically stabilized wall.
b. Disadvantage. The precast concrete modular retaining wall could
sustain cracking of interior connecting members due to relatively small
(0.5 foot per 100 feet of wall length) longitudinal differential settlement.
10-16. Design Considerations. Various engineering companies involved will
provide site-specific plans and limited designs for their proprietary system.
Stability is evaluated in a manner similar to a conventional gravity retaining
wall. For stability calculations the interlocking precast concrete modular
system is assumed to behave as a coherent block. The system must be stable
*
10-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
BEAM
TOP KEY
LIFTING HOLE
WIDTH
[]
TYPICAL TOP MODULE- A
LEVELING PAD
[,
I~
Figure 10-5.
10-15
dJ
~('o",
D'", 01oC.
OCO'<:'()Y
rMASONITESHIM
(TYPJ
r'"
0
RUBBER
PADS
FRONT
FACE
REAR
FACE
LATERAL
LOCK
CORNER
10-16
LOCK
I\..RUBB~R_/
,. :
'(J.
1
PADS
co'
~-
t';:,
c::;j'l
I: ... . I
PERFORMED CORK
JOINT FILLER
Figure. 10-6,
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
FILTER FABRIC
(TYPJ
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
FALSE HEADER
FRONT STRETCHER
IIH3
._..,.....__~:::::;fci;;:::::--~.o..-f...::: -- -- _.__TCK
'-'"r-=--Jc.),--=--I>("::J;/_.---;,?
COMPACTED G RANULAR
FILL
__L
NOTE: FALSEHEADERSARE
NOT USED IN THE INTERIOR
SECTIONS OF MULTIPLE
DEPTH WALLS.
,t:pCr/v,
E /.1//DrH
1 '-3"
,.
2'6"
2'-6"
~TRETCHE~ f 5'-0"
1TR E;cH"EA I
2'-6"
kTRETCHE~
2'-6"
5'-0"
STRETCHER
5'.()
;=t50
~TRETCHE~
4"
I STRETCHER
u.
~j
t=1 '
tj~
4"
8"
4"
8"
4"
8"
4"
8"
4"
}==I 8"
4"
Figure 10-7.
10-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
RETAINING WALL
FOUNDATION DIMENSIONS
4
TRENCH WIDTH
LENGTH
LEDGE
DEPTH
FROST DEPTH
PEDESTAL OR PIER
FOOTINGS
SECTION
f
20'
20'
~----------~--------~----------~~--------~ELEVATION
=:JI
llf
'
'
I I I~ :
'
'-t-'
ill
,,
,IJI,
~-r~
'
'
'
Lt..J
79'-71"
Figure 10-8.
JlL
Jll
Jll
,,
"
,,
"
PLAN VIEW
'
,,
6'-8"
6'-8"
6'-8"
'
,,,,,
,,
~ f :I
II
-,
'-1-'
I ~
I 11
'
'
~tj
19'-77"
1"
20'
'
'
1~'
I i\1 .
,.._,__
'
!-+-i
,,
t-;
~
~
'
II
JIL
'
II
:.. ,_,:
: -,'
'--'.:
Jjt
a
I
Jn
20'
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
against sliding along the base of the structure, overturning about the toe of
the wall, bearing capacity failure of the foundation soil, differential settlement, and overall slope stability.
a. Sliding Along The Base Of The Structure. The precast concrete modular
system must be stable against sliding due to the lateral pressure of the soil
retained by the system. The minimum factor of safety against sliding should be
1.5.
b. Overturning About The Toe Of The Wall. The precast concrete modular
system must be stable against overturning about the toe of the wall. Since the
concrete modular units are not tied together vertically, the stability against
overturning must be checked at each concrete module level for a given width.
One hundred percent of the base should always be in contact with the subgrade
for all loading conditions (Elias 1986). Normally overturning (not sliding)
criteria govern the design.
c. Bearing Capacity Failure and Settlement. The precast concrete modular
system must be stable against bearing capacity failure of the foundation soil.
The minimum factor of safety against bearing capacity failure should be 3.0
(Elias 1986). If the foundation does not meet stability requirements,
consideration should be given to use of a mechanically stabilized backfill
system or ground improvement techniques such as stone columns, vibroflotation,
and dynamic compaction to improve foundation stability. As previously stated,
the precast concrete modular retaining wall could sustain cracking of interior
connecting members due to relatively small (0.5 foot per 100 feet of wall
length) longitudinal differential settlement. Precast concrete modular retaining walls are also susceptible to damage from differential settlement
perpendicular to the wall face, particularly on high walls where the bottom
wall units may be as wide as 20 feet.
d. Overall Slope Stability. The precast concrete modular system, retained soil, and foundation should be stable against slope failure. All
potential slip surfaces should be investigated including deep-seated sliding.
The minimum factor of safety for slope stability should be 1.5.
e. Drainage. Drainage measures must be considered for all precast concrete modular systems to prevent saturation of the soil backfill. Also, for
closed-face modular systems (see Figure 10-5), a geotextile is placed over all
joints on the back side of the front face of the wall to prevent fines from
migrating from behind the wall.
10-17. Construction Considerations. The construction of precast concrete
modular systems does not require specialized contractors, skilled labor, or
special equipment. The components are prefabricated providing ease of handling
and forming and relatively quick construction. Soil backfill within the precast modular units should receive adequate compaction to minimize postconstruction settlements.
10-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
10-18. Instrumentation and Monitoring. The history of precast concrete
modular systems is relatively short compared to the design life of the structure.* Therefore, continued accumulation of field data is necessary to verify
design assumptions. Structures should be instrumented and monitored whenever
atypical conditions exist such as anticipated large differential vertical
settlement. Measurements should be made of horizontal and vertical displacements of the front face of the wall and soil pressures on the rear face of the
wall. All precast concrete modular structures should be monitored once they
are placed in operation to ensure stability. Stability of the precast concrete
modular structure could be threatened by the same factors as a conventional
retaining wall; e.g., clogging of the drainage system, erosion at the toe of
the wall, etc. Precast concrete modular structures should also be monitored
for possible damage from differential settlements.
10-19. Maintenance and Repair. Since precast concrete modular structures are
relatively new, there is very limited field experience regarding maintenance
and repair. Possible methods of repair to a section of the structure which has
sustained damage from differential settlement include replacing the section
with a wall more tolerant to differential settlement, such as a mechanically
stabilized embankment system with vertical joints (see Figure 10-2) or a
steel-bin type wall, or placing a stone buttress in front of the structure.
10-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX A
REFERENCES
Government Publications
Department of the Army, Corps of Engineers*
Engineer Regulations
ER 1110-1-803
Constructibility
ER 1110-2-100
ER 1110-2-1806
ER 1130-2-339
Technical Manuals
TM 5-818-1
Engineer Manuals
EM 1110-1-1804
Geotechnical Investigations
EM 1110-1-2101
EM 1110-1-2009
Architectural Concrete
EM 1110-2-301
EM 1110-2-1410
EM 1110-2-1601
Available from:
Hyattsville, MD
A-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
EM 1110-2-1901
EM 1110-2-1902
EM 1110-2-1903
EM 1110-2-1904
EM 1110-2-1905
EM 1110-2-1906
EM 1110-2-1907
Soil Sampling
EM 1110-2-1908
EM 1110-2-1911
EM 1110-2-1913
EM 1110-2-2000
EM 1110-2-2102
EM 1110-2-2103
EM 1110-2-2906
EM 1110-2-4300
EM 1120-2-109
Guide Specifications
CW 02215
CW 03301
CW 03305
Mass Concrete
A-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Agostinelli, V. M., et al. 1981 (Feb). "Program Criteria Specifications
Document for Computer Program TWDA for Design and Analysis of Inverted-T
Retaining Walls and Floodwalls." Available from: U. S. Army Engineer
Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Al-Hussani, M. M., and Perry, E. B. 1976 (Sep). "Effect of Horizontal Reinforcement on Stability of Earth Masses," Technical Report S-76-11, U. S.
Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS
39180.
Al-Hussani, M.
forcement
ASCE, Vol
Waterways
M., and Perry, E. B. 1978 (Mar). "Field Experiment of ReinEarth Wall," Journal of the Geotechnical Engineering Division,
104, No. GT3, pp 307-322. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer
Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
A-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Caquot, A., and Kerisel, J. 1948. Tables for the Calculation of Passive
Pressure, Active Pressure, and Bearing Capacity of Foundations (translated by M. A. Bec, London), Gauthier-Villars, Paris.
Carroll, R. G., Jr., and Murphy, J. C. 1985 (May-Jun). "Drainage Objective:
Prefabricated Drainage Composites," Geotechnical Fabrics Report, Vol 3,
No. 3, pp 14-18.
Casagrande, A. 1937. "Seepage Through Dams," Contributions to Soil
Mechanics, 1925-1949, Boston Society of Civil Engineers, Boston, MA,
pp 295-336.
Casagrande, Leo. 1973 (Feb). "Comments of Conventional Design of Retaining
Structures," Journal, Soil Mechanics and Foundations Division, American
Society of Civil Engineers, Vol 99, No. SM 2, pp 181-197. Available
from: ASCE Publication Fulfillment, 345 East 47th Street, New York, NY
10017.
Cedergren, Harry R. 1967.
Sons, New York.
Collin, J. C. 1986 (May). "Earth Wall Design," Ph.D. Dissertation, University of California, Berkeley. Available from: University Microfilms
International, 300 North Zeeb Road, Ann Arbor, MI 48106.
Criblock Retaining Walls of America, Inc. "Criblock Interlocking Concrete
Criblock." Available from: Criblock Retaining Wall of America, Inc.,
P. O. Box 849, Sierra Madre, CA 91024.
Danish Geotechnical Institute. 1978. "Code of Practice for Foundation Engineering," Danish Geotechnical Institute, Copenhagen, Denmark, Bulletin
No. 32, p 52.
Das, B. M. 1984. Principles of Foundation Engineering, Brooks/Cole Engineer
ing Division, Monterey, CA.
Department of the Navy. 1982a (May). "Soil Mechanics," NAVFAC DM-7.1.
Available from: Department of the Navy, Naval Facilities Engineering
Command, 200 Stovall St., Alexandria, VA 22332.
Department of the Navy. 1982b (May). "Foundations and Earth Structures,"
NAVFAC DM-7.2. Available from: Department of the Navy, Naval Facilities
Engineering Command, 200 Stovall St., Alexandria, VA 22332.
Doublewal Corp. 1984. "Doublewal Interlocking Precast Retaining Wall System
Field Manual." Available from: Doublewal Corp., 59 East Main St.,
Plainville, CT 06062.
A-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Driscoll, D. D. 1979 (Dec). Retaining Wall Design Guide, Foundation Services, Inc., Portland, OR, Prepared for USDA Forest Service. Available
from: USDA Forest Service Region 6, 319 S.W. Pine St., Portland, OR
97208.
Duncan, J. M., and Buchignani, A. L. 1976 (Jun). "An Engineering Manual for
Settlement Studies," Department of Civil Engineering, University of
California, Berkeley.
Elias, V. 1986. "Retaining Walls," Draft Bridge Design Manual, Part 4,
Structures, Section 5, Pennsylvania Department of Transportation.
Available from: V. Elias and Associates, 6809 Carlynn Court, Bethesda,
MD 20817.
Evergreen Systems, Inc. "Retaining Walls." Available from:
Systems, Inc., P. O. Box 345, Kings Point, NY 11754.
Evergreen
Forsyth, R. A. 1979. "Alternate Earth Reinforcements," Proceedings, Symposium on Earth Reinforcement, American Society of Civil Engineers,
pp 358-370. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment
Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Frondistou-Yannas, S. 1985 (Jan). "Corrosion Susceptibility of Internally
Reinforced Soil Retaining Structures," Report No. FHWA-RD-83-105, U. S.
Department of Transportation, Federal Highway Administration. Available
from: Federal Highway Administration, Turner-Fairbank Highway Research
Center, 6300 Georgetown Pike, McLean, VA 22101.
Geotechnical Control Office. 1982 (Jun). Guide to Retaining Wall Design,
Geoguide 1, Engineering Development Department, Hong Kong. Available
from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631,
Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Godfrey, K. A., Jr. 1984 (Dec). "Retaining Walls: Competition or Anarchy?",
Civil Engineering, Vol 54, No. 12, pp 48-52. Available from: U. S. Army
Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS
39180.
Harr, M. E. 1977. Mechanics of Particulate Media, McGraw-Hill, New York.
Available from: McGraw-Hill International Book Company, 1221 Avenue of
the Americas, New York, NY 10020.
Harr, M. E.
1962.
Available from:
Hilfiker
A-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Ingold, T. S. 1979b. "The Effect of Compaction on Retaining Walls,"
Geotechnique, Vol 29, No. 3, pp 265-283.
Ireland, H. O. 1964 (Aug). "Design and Construction of Retaining Walls,"
Design of Structures to Resist Earth Pressure, Soil Mechanics Lecture
Series, Department of Civil Engineering, Illinois Institute of Technology, Chicago, IL. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Jackura, K. A. 1984 (May). "Results of Minor Research on Bar-Mat Pullout
Tests," CA/TL-84-08, California Department of Transportation, Sacramento,
CA.
Jaky, J. 1944. "The Coefficient of Earth Pressure At-Rest," Journal, Society
of Hungarian Architects and Engineers, Budapest, Hungary, pp 355-358.
Jones, C. J. F. P. 1985. Earth Reinforcement and Soil Structures,
Butterworths, London. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways
Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Kenney, T. C. 1959. Discussion of "Geotechnical Properties of Glacial
Clays," by T. H. Wu, Journal of the Soil Mechanics and Foundations Division, ASCE, Vol 85, No. SM3, pp 67-79.
Kraemer, S. R., and Smith, A. D. 1986 (Oct). "Geocomposite Drains," Vol I,
Engineering Assessment and Preliminary Guidelines, Report No. FHWA-RD86-171, U. S. Department of Transportation, Federal Highway Administration. Available from: Federal Highway Administration, 6300 Georgetown
Pike, McLean, VA 22101.
Leary, R. M., and Klinedinst, G. L. 1984 (May). "Retaining Wall Alternates,"
Proceedings, 34th Annual Highway Geology Symposium, Atlanta, GA. Available from: Federal Highway Administration, Geotechnical and Materials
Branch, 400 7th St., S.W., Washington, DC 20590.
Liu, Tony C., and Gleason, Scott. 1981 (Dec). "Strength Design of Reinforced
Concrete Hydraulic Structures," Technical Report SL-80-4, U. S. Army
Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Vicksburg, MS. Available from:
US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg,
MS 39180.
Long, N. T., et al. 1984 (May). "Repair of a Reinforced Earth Wall," Proceedings, International Conference on Case Histories in Geotechnical
Engineering, Vol 1, pp 335-339, University of Missouri-Rolla, Rolla, MO.
Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O.
Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Marcuson, W. F., and Bieganousky, W. A. 1977 (Nov). "SPT and Relative Den
sity in Coarse Sands," Journal of the Geotechnical Engineering Division,
ASCE, Vol 103, No. GT11, pp 1295-1309.
A-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Massarsch, K. R. 1979. "Lateral Earth Pressure in Normally Consolidated
Clays," Proceedings of the Seventh European Conference on Soil Mechanics
and Foundation Engineering, Brighton, England, Vol 2, pp 245-249.
Matsuo, M., Kenmochi, S., Yagi, H. 1978 (Sep). "Experimental Study on Earth
Pressure of Retaining Wall by Field Tests," Soils and Foundations,
Japanese Society of Soil Mechanics and Foundation Engineering, Vol 18,
No. 3, pp 27-41. Available from: Japanese Society of Soil Mechanics and
Foundation Engineering, Suga-yama Building-4F, Kanda Awaji-cho 2-23
Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 101, Japan.
McGee, P. E. 1985 (Nov). "Reinforced Earth Wall Strip Serviceability Study,"
Special Research Study No. 8405, Geotechnical Engineering Bureau, Office
of Materials and Research, Georgia Department of Transportation, Forest
Park, GA. Available from: Engineering Design Unit, Georgia Department
of Transportation, Office of Materials and Research, 15 Kennedy Drive,
Forest Park, GA 30050.
McGown, A., et al. 1985. "The Load-Strain-Time Behavior of Tensor Geogrids,"
Proceedings, Conference on Polymer Grid Reinforcement, pp 11-17, Thomas
Telford Ltd., London. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways
Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
McKittrick, D. 1979. "Design Construction, Technology, and
Reinforced Earth Structures," Proceedings, Symposium on
ment, American Society of Civil Engineers, pp 596-616.
U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O.
Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Performance of
Earth ReinforceAvailable from:
Box 631,
Meyerhof, G. G. 1956. "Penetration Tests and Bearing Capacity of Cohesionless Soils," Journal of the Soil Mechanics and Foundations Divisions,
ASCE, Vol 82, No. SM1, pp 1-19.
Mitchell, J. K., Villet, W. C. B., and DiMillio, A. F. 1984 (Dec). "Soil
Reinforcement for Stabilization of Earth Slopes and Embankments," Public
Roads, U. S. Department of Transportation, Vol 48, No. 3, pp 88-95.
Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station,
P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Mitchell, J. K., and Villet, W. C. B., eds. 1986. "Reinforcement of Earth
Slopes and Embankments," 4 Vols, National Cooperative Highway Research
Program Project 24-2, National Research Council, Transportation Research
Board, Washington, DC. Available from: National Cooperative Highway
Research Program, 2101 Constitution Avenue, N.W., Washington, DC 20418.
Mosher, Reed L., and Pace, Michael E. 1982 (Jun). Users Guide: Computer
Program for Bearing Capacity Analyses of Shallow Foundations (CBEAR),
Instruction Report K-82-7, U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Vicksburg, MS. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways
Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
A-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Pace, Michael E, Noddin, Virginia R., 1987 (Oct). "Sliding Stability of Concrete Structures (CSLIDE)," Instruction Report ITL-87-5. Available from:
U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631,
Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Pace, Michael E., Williams, Dennis R., Wolff, Thomas F., and Mosher, Reed.
1984 (Sep). "Seepage Analysis of Confined Flow Problems by the Method of
Fragments (CFRAG)," Instruction Report K-84-8. Available from:
U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631,
Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Peck, R. B., and Bazaraa, A. S. 1969. "Discussion on Settlement of Spread
Footings on Sand," Journal of the Soil Mechanics and Foundations Division, ASCE, Vol 95, No. SM3, pp 905-909.
Peck, R. B., Hanson, W. E., and Thornburn, T. H.
ing, 2nd. ed., Wiley, New York.
1974.
Foundation Engineer-
A-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Shields, D. H., and Tolunay, A. Z. 1973. "Passive Pressure Coefficients by
Method of Slices," Journal of the Soil Mechanics and Foundations Division, ASCE, Vol 99, No. SM12, pp 1043-1053.
Sibley, E. A. 1967. "Backfill Adjacent to Structures," Proceedings of the
Montana Conference on Soil Mechanics and Foundation Engineering, Department of Civil Engineering, Montana State University, Bozeman, MT.
Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station,
P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Smith, A. D., and Kraemer, S. R. 1987 (Feb). "Creep of Geocomposite Drains,"
Proceedings, Geosynthetic 87 Conference, New Orleans, LA, Vol 2,
pp 422-433. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment
Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Spangler, M. G., and Mickle, J. 1956. "Lateral Pressure on Retaining Walls
Due to Backfill Surface Loads," Highway Research Board Bulletin 141,
pp 1-18.
Tcheng, Y., and Iseux, J. 1972. "Essais de Butee en Vraie Grandeur et Con
straintes Engendrees par une Surcharge Rectangulaire sur un Mur Vertical," Proceedings, 5th European Conference on Soil Mechanics and Foundation Engineering, Madrid.
Tensar Corp., "Tensar." 1984. Available from:
zens Parkway, Morrow, GA 30260.
1943.
A-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Tracy, Fred T. 1983 (Sep). "Users Guide for a Plane and Axisymmetric Finite
Element Program for Steady-State Seepage Problems," Instruction
Report K-83-4, U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station,
Vicksburg, MS. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment
Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Tschebatarioff, G. 1949. "Large Scale Earth Pressure Tests with Model Flexible Bulkheads," Final Report to U. S. Navy, Bureau of Yards and Docks,
Princeton University.
U. S. Army Engineer Division, Ohio River. 1958 (Jun). "Final Report on Fullsize Floodwall (T-type) Stability Test." Available from HQUSACE Library.
VSL Corporation,
A-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Whitman, R. V., and Liao, S. 1985 (Jan). Seismic Design of Gravity Retaining
Walls, Miscellaneous Paper GL-85-1, U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Winterkorn, H. F., and Fang, H-Y., eds. 1975.
book, Van Nostrand-Reinhold, New York.
Wu, T. H.
1966.
A-11
EM 1110-2-2502
31 Mar 89
APPENDIX B
BIBLIOGRAPHY
B-1
EM 1110-2-2502
31 Mar 89
Goldberg-Zoino & Associates, Inc. "Report on Full Scale Field Test of TwentyTwo Foot High Doublewal," May 1983; Report to Doublewal Corporation,
Newton Upper Falls, MA. Available from: Doublewal Corp., 59 East Main
St., Plainville, CT 06062.
Hilfiker Company. 1984. "Reinforced Soil Embankment." Available from:
Hilfiker Company, 3900 Broadway, Eureka, CA 95501.
International Society for Rock Mechanics, Commission on Standardization of
Laboratory and Field Tests. "Suggested Methods for Determining Shear
Strengths," Document No. 1, February 1974. Available from: Printing and
Publishing Office, National Academy of Sciences--National Research
Council, 2101 Constitution Ave., N.W., Washington, DC 20418.
McKittrick, D. P. "Reinforced Earth: Application of Theory and Research to
Practice," Proceedings, Symposium on Soil Reinforcing and Stabilizing
Techniques in Engineering Practice, Vol 2, October 1978, pp 1-44.
Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O.
Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Neilson, M. R. Pullout Resistance of Welded Wire Mats Embedded in Soil, 1984,
M.S. Thesis, Department of Civil Engineering, University of Utah, Logan,
UT. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station,
P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Netlon Limited. "Guidelines for the Design and Construction of Reinforced
Soil Retaining Walls Using Tensar Geogrids," 1982. Available from: The
Tensar Corp., 1210 Citizens Parkway, Morrow, GA 30260.
Netlon Limited. "Tensar Test Methods and Physical Properties of Tensar
Geogrids," 1984. Available from: The Tensar Corp., 1210 Citizens
Parkway, Morrow, GA 30260.
Peterson, L. M., and Anderson, L. R. "Pullout Resistance of Welded Wire Mesh
Embedded in Soil," 1980, Department of Civil Engineering, University of
Utah, Logan, UT. Available from: U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180.
Price, William A., et al. Users Guide: Computer Program for Design and
Analysis of Inverted-T Retaining Walls and Flood Walls (TWDA), Instruction Report K-80-6 and K-80-7, December 1980, U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Vicksburg, MS. Available from: U. S. Army
Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, P. O. Box 631, Vicksburg, MS.
39180.
Reinforced Earth Company. "Reinforced Earth Retaining Walls,"
Brochure 2.18b/RE, 1980. Available from: Reinforced Earth Company,
Rosslyn Center, 1700 North Moore St., Arlington, VA 22209.
B-2
EM 1110-2-2502
31 Mar 89
Selvage, Heber, Nelson and Associates, Inc. "Engineering Analysis of the
Gridcote System," April 1984. Available from: Hilfiker Co.,
3900 Broadway, Eureka, CA 95501.
VSL Corporation. "General Specification for Retaining Earth Walls," July
1984. Available from: VSL Corporation, 101 Albright Way, Los Gatos, CA
95030.
VSL Corporation. "Retained Earth, Field Erection Manual," March 1983. Available from: VSL Corporation, 101 Albright Way, Los Gatos, CA 95030.
VSL Corporation. "Retained Earth Walls, Design Procedure for Standard Walls,"
March 1984. Available from: VSL Corporation, 101 Albright Way,
Los Gatos, CA 95030.
Welti, C. "Soil-Concrete Interaction Tests of 12 Wide Doublewal," October
1982, Glastonbury, CT. Available from: Doublewal Corporation, 59 East
Main St., Plainville, CT 06062.
B-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX C
NOTATION
Chapters 3, 4, and 5
Symbol
Term
b
B
_
B
Hydrodynamic factor
Water depth
d
1
2
E
f
b
c
s
D
FS
Factor of safety
Magnification factor
T
h
C-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Symbol
Term
H
b
L
Li
Any horizontal force applied above the top or below the bottom
of the left side adjacent wedge
Ri
Any horizontal force applied above the top or below the bottom
of the right side adjacent wedge
1
i
Horizontal acceleration in gs
Vertical acceleration in gs
h
v
K
AE
i
o
layer
PE
L
N ,N ,N
c q r
wedge
C-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Symbol
Term
p
p
hz
p
vi
PH
P
P
cr
z
layer
AH
th
AE
D
E
EE
i-1
p
hm
AH
(P
- P )
i
P
PH
th
wedge
PE
Internal water force acting on the side of the wedge free body
R
W
ws
o
Q
C-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Symbol
Term
SMF
F
U
i
V
angle
th
Any vertical force applied above the top of the i
wedge
max
W
Maximum value of
are valid
and
th
Line of action of
Line of action of
AE
PE
z
z
cr
z
wedge
AE
PE
th
layer
p
hm
th
C-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Symbol
Term
th
layer
sat
tan
tan
tan c
due to surcharge
HX
HZ
AE
PE
C-5
due to surcharge
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX D
NOTATION
Chapter 9
Symbol
Term
A
s
f
c
f
s
y
h
D-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Symbol
Term
u
b
n
u
U
c
W
A /bd
s
Maximum percentage of
D-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX E
COMPARISON OF DANISH CODE AND JAKY EQUATIONS FOR AT-REST
COEFFICIENT WITH COULOMB COEFFICIENT FOUND USING
REDUCED SHEAR STRENGTH PARAMETER <l>d
<l>d
Jaky, Equation 3-4
Table E-1
At-Reot p;arth Pressure Coefficients for Comear1son of Couloab's Eguation with an SKF of 2/3
to the D8nish Code and Jakl Egunttons
Tnclined Bsckf1 I 1
Horizontal Backfill
K
K
0
(des)
(red)
~!zl
10
II
12
I3
14
IS
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
0.175
0.192
0. 209
0. 227
0.244
0.262
o. 279
0.297
0.314
0.332
0. 349
0. 367
0. 384
0.401
0.419
0.436
0.454
0.471
0.489
0.506
0.524
0.541
0.826
O.R09
0. 792
0. 775
0. 758
0. 741
0. 724
o. 708
0.691
0.674
0.658
0.642
0.625
0.609
0.593
0 0577
0. 562
0. 546
0. 53 I
0.515
0.500
0.485
0.4711
o. 455
() .441
0.426
0.412
0.198
0. 384
0. 371
0 035 7
0.144
0. 311
0. 318
0. 305
0.293
Jl
'}:.!
33
14
15
16
J7
18
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
Note:
n. s~q
0. 576
0. 591
0.611
0.628
0.646
0.661
0.681
0.698
0. 716
o. 733
0. 750
0. 768
o. 785
(SHF 2/3)
o. 791
0. 772
o, 754
0.736
o. 718
0. 701
0.684
0.667
0.651
0.634
0.618
0.603
0.587
0.572
0.557
0 0542
0.528
0.513
0.499
0.485
0.471
0.45R
0. 445
0.4 31
0.418
0.405
0 0393
0.180
0.368
0 0356
0.144
0.132
o. 320
o. 309
o. 298
0.286
B -10
KoB
(Oanioh)
0.683
0.669
0.655
0.640
0.626
0.612
0.599
0.585
0. 571
0. 557
0.544
0.530
0. 517
0.503
0.490
0.477
0.464
0.451
0.418
0.476
0. 413
0.401
II. 1HH
0.176
o. 364
0.152
0. 341
0 0179
0.118
0.106
o. 295
0 0284
0.271
0 0261
0. 252
0. 242
B
K
(SMF 2/1)
0 0701
0.686
0.6M
0.653
0.638
0.622
0.607
0.593
0.578
0.564
0.550
o. 537
0. 523
0.510
0.497
0 0485
0.472
0.460
0.448
0.436
0.474
0.41 ~
KoB
rnaoiah)
0 0826
0.809
0. 792
0. 775
0 0758
0 0741
o. 724
0. 708
0.691
0 0674
0.658
0.642
0. 625
0.609
0. 593
0. 577
0 0562
o. 546
0. 53 I
0. 515
0. 500
0.4R~
O.ftflO
II. '70
0.189
0 0378
o. 167
o. 356
0.145
0. 334
0. 321
0. 311
0.103
o. 292
0 0282
0. 272
o. 26)
0. 455
0 0441
0.426
0 0412
0 0398
0 0384
0. 371
o. 357
0 0344
0. 31 I
0.118
0. 305
0 0291
> ~d
E-1
B~
o
K
iSHF 2/3)
KoS
(Oanioh)
(SHF 2/1)
B 20
K
KoB
0
(Danlsh) (SHF 713)
o. 791
0.772
o. 754
0. 7)6
0. 718
0. 701
0.684
0.667
0.651
0.614
0.618
0.603
o. 587
o. 572
() 0557
0 0542
0 0528
0 0513
0.499
() .485
0.47 I
o .4sR
0.970
0.950
0.930
0.910
0.890
0.870
0.850
0.831
0.81 I
0. 792
0. 772
0 0753
o. 7J4
0 0715
0.696
0.678
0.659
0.641
0 0623
0. 60S
0 0~87
0 0569
II. ')'o!
11.'.111
n.t~
o. 4 31
0.418
() 0~)4
0. 517
0. 500
0.484
0.467
0 0451
0 04 35
0.419
0.404
0.18R
0. 171
ll. 158
0 0144
0.4?4
0 04 78
0.611
().597
o. sn
() 055)
0 0534
o. 516
0.497
0.479
n. 462
0.444
0.477
0.410
0 0391
,,_,,,,.,
0.40~
o. 1Y1
0.180
0.168
0 0156
() .144
0 0332
o. 170
0.109
o. 298
0. 286
0.931
0.871
0.833
0.802
0. 774
o. 748
o. 724
o. 70~
0.680
0 0659
0.618
0.619
0.599
0.581
0 0563
0.545
0. 577
0.!.1\?
0 .l14b
0.411
0.416
0.401
0.186
0
37~
0 01~8
0 0345
0.111
0. JIR
0.883
0.861
0.839
0.818
0. 796
0. 775
0. 754
0. 733
0. 712
0.691
0.671
0. 6~ I
'I
O.M09
0 0747
O,(,CJ(,
II. frhll
0.627
0 0598
o.r,7:'
II. 54 7
0 0571
0. SOl
0.4 79
0 0459
0.439
u .470
0.402
o. 384
n. 161
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX F
DERIVATION OF GENERAL WEDGE EQUATION FOR SINGLE
WEDGE ANALYSIS (EQUATION 3-23)
F-1. Effective horizontal earth force. Given the following driving wedge, an
equation for P
, the effective horizontal earth force, will be derived.
EE
Solving for
yields,
F-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Setting the summation of forces parallel to the slip plane equal to zero
yields
Solving for T from Equation F-3 and substituting this expression into
Equation F-2 yields,
(H
- H
- P ) cos + (V + W) sin
W
- P
EE
[(HL
- H
EE
F-2.
Soil parameters.
parameters
- P ) sin + U - (V + W) cos
W
- P
EE
yields,
For a particular
and
tan - cL = 0
soil
EE
= (V + W)
+ H - H - P
L
R
W
F-3. Resisting wedge. The same procedure can be applied to a resisting wedge
to yield the following equation for P
.
EE
F-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(1 + tan
P
EE
= (W + V)
cot ) tan
U tan - c L
d
d
d
(1 - tan tan )
cos (1 - tan tan )
d
d
- H + H - P
L
R
W
F-3
EE
will
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX G
DERIVATION OF EQUATIONS FOR CRITICAL SLIP-PLANE
ANGLE () FOR DRIVING AND RESISTING WEDGES
G-1. Derivation of Critical Slip-Plane Angle () for Driving Wedges for the
Static Condition. In the following paragraphs the equations for the critical
slip-plane angle () will be derived for the static case for a driving wedge.
a. Introduction.
omitted is:
where
h - d
c
cos (tan - tan )
G-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Inserting the terms for
and
c(h - d )
c
2
cos (tan - tan )(1 + tan tan )
1
2
2
= sec = 1 + tan
2
cos
all terms over a common denominator
and putting
b. First Derivative of
that are associated with
Term.
yields,
G-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
ndm
dP
EE
=
d
m dn
The denominator may be neglected because it is the same for all terms in
Equation G-2.
c. First Derivative of
that are associated with c
Let
c Term.
yields,
-c(h - d ) = a
c
G-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
G-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
e.
Summation of Terms.
2
sec
G-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2
In Equation G-7, let the coefficient of tan equal A , let the coefficient of tan equal -Ac , and let the third coefficient equal -Ac .
1
2
Equation G-7 yields
G-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2
A tan
2
tan
- Ac tan - Ac = 0
1
2
- c tan - c = 0
1
2
and
or
The coefficients
and
are defined as
where
G-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
G-2.
G-3. Equations for Critical Slip-Plane Angles for Resisting Wedges for the
Static Condition. The following equations, for resisting wedges, where
derived from Equation 3-33 in the same manner used for deriving the driving
wedge equations for the static condition.
G-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Note:
G-4. Effect of Water on Critical Slip-Plane Angle. The unit weight of soil
() to use in equations for calculating the slip-plane angle should be the
average unit weight of soil in the wedge. The average unit weight is determined by using the moist unit weight of soil above the water table and the
buoyant unit weight below the water table. The effect of seepage should be
taken into account in determining the buoyant unit weight. See Appendices M
and N for example calculations.
G-5. Derivation of Equations for Critical Slip-Plane Angle () for Driving
Wedges for Earthquake Condition. The equations for the critical slip-plane
angle () for a driving wedge as shown in the figure below for the dynamic
case will be derived.
a.
yields
Summation of Forces.
G-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N = W cos + P
sin - k W sin
h
AE
The shearing force
T = N tan + cL = (W cos + P
AE
Summing forces parallel to slip plane and inserting the expression for
yields
AE
+ cL = 0
AE
AE
yields
W[(1 + k
P
AE
and
c(h - d )
c
cos (tan - tan )(cos + tan sin )
G-10
AE
yields
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Using the trigonometric relationship
sec
1
2
cos
2
2c(h - dc) sec
2(tan - tan )(1 + tan tan )
b.
First Derivative of
sec
2
= 1 + tan
with respect to
AE
resulting expression is solved for the critical value of
derivative is equal to
of
and rearranging
The first
1 + k
tan = a ,
= b ,
G-11
and
1 - tan tan = d
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Then:
n == tan
dm
da ""
sec
dn
da (2 tan
n -dm = ( a tan
da
tan a + d) sec
tan
a tan
4c
B - y(h + d ) tan
tan
4c
=[2
a + ad tan a - a tan
y(h + d ) d tan
m -dn
da
tan
4c
a + y(h + d ) tan
c
B tan a ] sec 2 a
4c
tan a
4c
3
2c
y(h + d ) tan ~ tan a + ad tan a - bd - y(h + d ) d
c
G-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
dn
dm
m-- nda
da
2
sec a
[-a tan
2c
y(h + d )
c
d] tan 2 a
4c
2c
+ [-a tan B + bd + y(h + d )
c
1 +
Substitute
for d
tan
for
a ,
tan
d]
for
4c
2(tan ~ - kh) tan ~ + y(h + d ) (tan B + tan
and
1 - tan
tan B
tan a
[-(I
~ tan )
tan S + (tan -
~)(I
tan 0 tan S)
4c
2 tan ~ (tan ~ - ~) + y(h + de) (tan ~ + tan 8)
2
tan
a (1
+ kh tan
~) tan ~
tan a
2c
+ y(h + d ) (1 - tan
~ tan
8)
2c
G-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
then
where
G-6. Equations for Critical Slip-Plane Angles for Resisting Wedges for
Earthquake Condition. The equations for the critical slip-plane angle () for
a resisting wedge are derived in the same manner used for the driving wedges.
The resulting equations are
G-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
G-7. Procedure for Finding the Critical Slip-Plane Angle, for a Wedge in a
Layer Below the Top Layer, of a Stratified Backfill. A layered soil system is
shown in the figure on the following page.
In order to find the critical slip-plane angle for layer 2, the weight of soil
in layer 1 will be considered a surcharge supported by layer 2. See figure
below.
G-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
The weight of soil in parallelogram ABCD of the figure is a uniformly distributed surcharge that varies with . The uniformly distributed surcharge
2
does not affect the angle , but does have the effect of increasing the
2
unit weight of soil in wedge 2. The increased soil unit weight is calculated
as follows.
= increased unit weight
and
may be determined from Equations 3-25, 3-28, 3-29, and 3-30. See the figure
on the following page.
G-16
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Note that
.
2
G-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2) Using trial value of
(Equation G-11) V .
, calculate
2
If
(5) Use
procedure.
Stop.
b.
Example:
Find
2(0.12)(12)
2(0.12)(0.4 - 0.1)
+ 0.13 +
10
tan - 0.1
2
= 0.418 +
If
(6)
from
0.072
tan - 0.1
2
G-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
From Equation G-11,
V =
2
0.12(10) (0.4 - 0.1)
= 2
2 tan - 0.1
2
(1)
(a)
First trial:
1.80
tan
- 0.1
= 20 , c = 0)
2
2
= 0.4980 ,
V = -2.2222
2(-2.2222)(1.132474)
= 0.465038
2
0.4980(10)
A = 0.36398 -
4(-2.2222)(0.1)(1.132474)
2
0.4980(10)
= 0.613200
0.465038
0.264948 c =
1
2(-2.2222)(0.01)(1.132474)
2
0.4980(10)
0.465038
= 47.75
2
c = 0.536971 ,
2
(b)
Second trial:
= 48.0 ,
48=
/ 45
= 0.4892 ,
0.022649(-1.7624)
= 0.445566
0.4892
A = 0.36397 -
0.004530(-1.7684)
0.4892
= 0.631260
0.445566
0.264948 c =
1
0.0002265(-1.7624)
0.4892
= 0.560875
0.445566
0.250723 +
c =
2
G-19
= -1.7624
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
= 48.45
2
(c)
48.5 =
/ 48
Third trial:
= 48.5 ,
2
= 0.4879 ,
V = 1.6957
0.022649(-1.6957)
= 0.442687
0.4879
A = 0.36397 -
0.004530(-1.6957)
0.4879
= 0.634064
0.442687
0.264948 c =
1
0.250723 +
c =
2
= 48.56
2
0.0002265(-1.6957)
0.4879
= 0.564588
0.442687
48.5
= 48.5
2
__________
(2)
(a)
First trial:
A =
= 45 ,
= 0 , c
= 0.4980 ,
= 0.8 ksf)
V
= -2.2222
2(0.8)
2(-2.2222)
= 0.410530
0.498(10)
2
0.498(10)
c = 2 tan = 0.2
1
2
-0.1 +
c =
2
2(0.8)
2(-2.2222)(0.01)
+
0.498(10)
2
0.498(10)
= 0.537936
0.410530
= 40.04
2
40
G-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(b)
Second trial:
= 40 ,
2
= 0.5154 ,
V = -3.2951
0.16
0.02(-3.7218)
= 0.438304
0.5154
0.5154
A =
-0.1 +
c = 0.2 , c =
1
2
= 38.59
2
(c)
0.16
0.0002(-3.2951)
+
0.5154
0.5154
= 0.477203
0.438304
38.5 =
/ 40
= 38.5 ,
2
Third trial:
= 0.5215 ,
V = -3.7218
0.16 - 0.02(-3.7218)
= 0.449542
0.5215
A =
-0.1 +
c = 0.2 , c =
1
2
= 38.07
2
(d)
38 =
/ 38.5
Fourth trial:
A =
0.16 + 0.0002(-3.7218)
0.5215
= 0.456865
0.449542
= 38 ,
2
= 0.5237 ,
V = -3.8781
0.16 - 0.02(-3.8781)
= 0.453622
0.5237
-0.1 +
c = 0.2 , c =
1
2
= 37.89
2
0.16 + 0.0002(-3.8781)
0.5237
= 0.449796
0.453622
38
= 38
2
________
G-21
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(3)
Check
2
2
0.12(10) (tan - tan )
0.13(10)
0.12(12)(10)
1
2
W =
+
+
2 (tan - 0.1)
tan - 0.1
2
2
2
2
tan - 0.1
2
W =
EE
20.9
+
tan - 0.1
2
EE
= 48.5:
2
EE
)2
- 0.1
22.9149(1.091309 - 0.36397)
= 11.9288 kips
1 + 0.36397(1.091309)
W = 21.9812 kips
21.9812(1.130294 - 0.36397)
= 11.9348 kips > 11.9288 kips
1 + 0.36397(1.130294)
= 49.5:
2
(tan 2
W = 22.9149 kips
EE
1.8
W (tan - tan )
2
2
1 + tan tan
2
2
= 47.5:
2
W = 21.0869 kips
21.0869(1.170850 - 0.36397)
= 11.9304 kips
1 + 0.36397(1.170850)
< 11.9348
Check
G-22
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
W =
EE
20.9
+
tan - 0.1
2
EE
EE
EE
L =
cos
10
(tan - 0.1)
2
2
L = 18.6268 ft
0.8(18.6268)
= 8.0875 kips > 0.0818
0.788011
W = 33.0185 kips ,
= 33.0185(0.809784) -
L = 19.1589 ft
0.8(19.1589)
= 8.0818 kips
0.798636
W = 34.5554 kips ,
= 34.5554(0.781286) -
= 39:
2
- 0.1
W = 36.1931 kips ,
= 36.1931(0.753554) -
= 38:
2
(tan 2
,
2
= W tan - c L/cos
2
2
= 37:
2
1.8
L = 18.1289 ft
0.8(18.1289)
= 8.0758 kips < 8.0875
0.777146
G-23
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX H
DERIVATION OF PRESSURE COEFFICIENTS FOR SOLUTION OF LATERAL
EARTH PRESSURE PROBLEMS
H-1.
Introduction.
a. Engineers are familiar with earth pressure coefficients and their use
in determining pressures and forces acting on retaining walls. The most
familiar and most often used are:
The above represent special cases of Coulombs equations for earth pressure
coefficients.
b.
(1)
(2) Any surcharge applied to the surface is uniform, and covers the
entire surface of the backfill wedge.
c. The general equations from which these simple coefficients are obtained are subject to the following limitations:
(1)
(4) Any surcharge must be uniform and cover the entire surface of the
backfill wedge.
d. The correct lateral earth force due to
tained from the general wedge equation, and the
subject to none of the above limitations. This
the most complicated problems of wedge geometry
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
solve complex earth pressure problems. The general wedge equation will now be
derived and the pressure coefficients obtained from the derived equation.
H-2.
In the derivation on the following pages it will be assumed that shear on the
vertical face of the wedge is zero.
H-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b. In the figure below, the forces acting on the wedge are shown along
with their components parallel and normal to the slip plane.
Setting the summation of forces parallel to the slip plane equal to zero:
P (cos + tan sin ) + (W + V) (tan cos - sin ) + cL = 0
P =
P :
L =
h - d
c
cos (tan tan )
and
(h2 -
2
c
W =
2 (tan - tan )
H-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
= unit weight of wedge material
c = cohesion
The equation for P will now be rewritten with the individual terms for
V , and c separated.
W ,
c.
(h2 -
Note that
and
)/
2
2 is the lateral
c
Everything in the second
d
.
1
term except V is the lateral coefficient for the strip surcharge and will be
called K . Everything in the third term except 2c(h - d ) is the lateral
v
c
coefficient for cohesion and will be called K .
c
d.
H-4
(11
- tan cot
+ tan tan
).
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
This is the lateral coefficient for when the top surface is a level
unbroken plane. This term will be called K . Therefore:
e.
and
1
and
It
f. The equation for the total lateral force (P) produced by a driving
wedge can now be written, where the wedge material possesses both cohesion and
internal friction, where the top surface is a sloping plane, where the top
surface supports a strip surcharge, and where the wedge is either completely
saturated or completely unsaturated. The equation is:
H-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
h.
H-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
The force reduction on each side of the wedge (-P) is represented by the
shaded parts of the pressure diagrams.
H-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
where
H-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
and
k. The effect of water is accounted for by using the average unit weight
of soil for in the above equations. The average unit weight is based on
the moist unit weight of soil above the water table and the buoyant unit
weight below the water table. The effect of seepage should be considered in
determining the buoyant weight.
H-3.
a. Pressure Coefficients.
side are
The term for cohesion (2K c) is positive for resisting pressure calculations,
c
not negative as it was for driving pressure. Therefore, the crack of depth
d
does not exist on the resisting side.
c
b. Critical Slip-Plane Angle.
angle for a resisting side wedge is
H-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Values for
and
c. With the above changes, the method for determining resisting pressures and forces is the same as for the driving case.
H-10
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX I
DERIVATION OF EQUATION FOR DEPTH OF CRACK
IN COHESIVE SOIL
I-1. Definition. By definition, the bottom of the crack will lie at the
depth where the net horizontal stress in the soil is zero.
where
The coefficients
and K
are derived in Appendix H.
1
c
Equation I-1 and solving for d
yields:
c
Rearranging
and
I-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX J
LATERAL PRESSURES DUE TO COMPACTION
J-1. Design pressure envelope. The design pressure envelope for nonyielding
walls with compaction effects will be derived. The lateral pressure due to
at-rest conditions is shown in Figure J-1.
Figure J-1.
J-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure J-2.
In Figure J-2,
where
where
cr
Taking
J-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
The horizontal pressure due to the earth and roller is
Using Equations J-2 and J-3 and solving for the critical depth
Assuming (1 - K K )
A o
cr
yields
cr
is
J-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure J-3.
J-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX K
DERIVATION OF VERTICAL SHEAR FORCE FOR UPWARD SLOPING BACKFILL
K-1. Derivation for Shear Required on Vertical Faces of Earth Wedges. When
the vertical face of an earth wedge does not lie on the same plane as the face
of the structural wedge, a shear force is required in order that the horizontal
earth force may be transferred between wedges.
A general situation where such a force is required is shown below in
Figure K-1.
Figure K-1.
The earth force calculated for wedge 1, using the provisions of the text, is a
force acting on Surface AB. In order for the same force to act on Surface CD,
a shear force must exist on vertical planes in Block ABCD. A free body of
Block ABCD is shown in Figure K-2.
K-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Figure K-2.
K-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
K-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX L
DERIVATION OF GENERAL WEDGE EQUATION FOR MULTIPLE WEDGE ANALYSIS
L-1.
Free-body diagram.
A free-body diagram of an i
th
L-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
and
sin (-a)
-sin a
- HR . cos (-a.)
+ P.1- l cos (-a.)
- P.1 cos (-a.)
1
1
1
1
Ni tan $i + ciLi
T.
where
T.
1
and
N.
tan ~i + ciLi
L-2
FS.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Solving for (P
i-1
- P ),
i
L-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX M
LATERAL EARTH PRESSURE COMPUTATIONS, EXAMPLES
SUMMARY OF EXAMPLES
SURCHARGE
WITH COMPACTION
EFFECTS
rp -
35
c .. 0 - - -
. 30
c 0
M-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
SURCHARGE
= 35
=0
= 35
(: = 0
30, c = 0
= 0, c = 0.60
9=
KSF
c
Kh
30
=0
= 0.2
"
Example 9, Page M-52
= 35
=0
M-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
LATERAL EARTH PRESSURE COMPUTATIONS, EXAMPLES
M-1.
EXAMPLE 1. Find the Lateral Earth Force and its pressure distribution
on Surface AB. Consider the effects of compaction in
accordance with paragraph 3-17.
a.
SMF = 1.00 ,
= = 30
[3-15]
[3-20]
b.
SMF = 2/3 ,
-1
= tan
M-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
M-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-2.
EXAMPLE 2.
a.
Calculate
.
[3-26]
[3-27]
[3-25]
M-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-6
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-3.
EXAMPLE 3.
M-7
The critical
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b. Lateral forces and pressure distribution. The lateral forces and
pressure distribution are shown in the figure below:
c.
M-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
PEE
w=
24.604
0.25
0.766400 + 1.016400
3.125
0.712834
EE
~d/cos
- Pw
32 3493 k/f
4.3839 k/ft
- 3.125
w=
24.604
0.25
33 8883 k/f
0.731531 + 0.981531 =
3.125
0.700486
EE
4.4612 k/ft
- 3.125
w=
24.604
0.697837
3.125
0.687924
13.3203 k/ft
0.25
+ 0.947837
35 5213 k/ft
4.5427 k/ft
M-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d.
Conclusion.
M-10
and
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-4.
EXAMPLE 4.
A = 0.169416
term)
M-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2 tan
~d
4V tan
ymh2
c1 --------A---=----2(0.466308)2- 4(6)(1/4)(1.217443)
2
0.12(20.25)
------~~~~~~~~--0.169416
1.690751
term)
2V tan
tan
c2
~d(l -
tan
~d
tan 8) - tan 8 +
(1
+ tan
2 ~d)
----..!..-h-:::----~
Ym
-------------~A---------~~-----
0.466308[0 - 0.466308(1/4)]
-.!. +
4
2 ( 6 ) 0/ 16) (1.217443)
0.12(20.25) 2
c 2 - --------------------..,..0-.1~6'"""9~4-16..,...----...;...;;...;;;..;;;..~~~-- - 1. 065442
[3-25]
b.
where:
Calculate
h2
Ym
Yavg [ .,..2~(t-a-n-=a---t-an-8:-:-)
Let
a 74.5778
M-12
Use
avg
instead of
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.12(20.25)
yavg = [ 2(3.374990)
y
avg
2
2
0.0575(16) ] . [ (20.25)
]
- 2(3.624990) 2(3.374990)
= 0.087 kef
A= 0.466308- 2 ( 6 )( 1 217443 )
2
0.087(20.25)
0.056802
2(0.466308)2- 4(6)(1/4)(1.217443)
2
0.087(20.25)
0.056802
4.051497
a = tan
-1 (c1 +
>
74.5778
Use: a = 74.5778 , the entire surcharge will not lie on the top surface of
the wedge when the angle is greater.
c. Calculate earth pressure coefficients (see Appendix H).
a= 65.354 (neglecting effect of water):
1 + tan cf>d cot a
K = 1
K = 1 - 0.466308(0.458807)
1 + 0.466308(2.179565)
0.389841
M-13
For
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
.179565)
K1 0.389841 ( 21.2!6!
0.44035
K1+ (
tan a
1 ym)]
tan a - tan S - )( Yb
[
K K tan a
v
K 0.389841(2.179565) 0.84968
v
For
K 1 - 0.466308(0.275863) 0 323883
1 + 0.466308(3.624990)
K1 0.323883 ( 3.624990)
3 374990 0.34787
3 624990
0 120
- 1)( 0.0625
0 323883[1 + ( 3.374990
)] 0.36995
K..
-0
K 0.323883(3.624990) 1.17407
v
d.
Py
(l/2)K 1Ym(h- h 8 )
py- (1/2)(0.44035)(0.12)(4.25)
For
a 65.354:
~Ybhs]
+ (1/2)(16)[2(0.44035)(0.12)(4.25)
+ 0.48682(0.0625)(168
py -
7.965 k/ft
M-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.84968(6)
7.965 + 5.098
PEE
For
KV
5.098 k/ft
13.063 k/ft
74.5778:
py
(1/2)(0.34787)(0.12)(4.25)
+ (1/2)(16)[2(0.34787)(0.12)(4.25)
+ 0.36995(0.0625)(16)]
p
p
6.175 k/ft
1.17407(6)
7.044 k/ft
13.219 k/ft
~d)
+ U tan
~d/cos
----------~~------~--------------- -
1 + tan
w=
~d
tan a
Simplifying
h2
Ym
(rs - Ymlh!
2 tan a
2 (tan a - tan f3) +
w= 2
2
2
(0.005) (16)
0.12(20.25)
2 tan a
(tan a - tan f3) +
ywh;
0.0625(16) 2
8
U = ..,.2-s;;....i,...:n_a =
2 sin a
= sin a
M-15
24.6038
+ 0.64
tan a - tan f3
tan a
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
ywhs
0.0625(16) 2
Pw = ---- =
= 8.000 k/ft
2
2
Let
= 73.5778
w=
u
24.6038
0.64
3.142854 + 3.392854
8.00
= 8 0171 k/ft
8.3402 k/ft ,
= 0.959205
w+ v =
14.0171 k/ft
1 + 0.466308(3.392854)
EE
- 8.000
Let
= 74.5778
24.6038
w = 3.374990
w+ v =
PEE
0.64
+ 3.624990
13.4666 k/ft ,
7 4666 k/ft
u = 0.~6~~92 = 8.2988
k/ft
Let
= 13.214 k/ft
(all of
75.5778
h
tan a - tan B
= 13.220 k/ft
20.25
3.638487
v = ( 5 565 ~ -
= 5.5655 ft
2
) 6 k/ft
M-16
5.3483 k/ft
> 13.214
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
24.6038
w = 3.638487
w+ v =
0.64
6 9267 k/f
+ 3.888487 ~
t
12.2750 k/ft ,
8/0.96847
8.2603
12.429 k/ft
<
13.220
SMF
1.00
2 tan$
c2
1.400416
tan 8
1 - tan $ tan 8 - tan $
(1/4)
1- 0.700208(1/4) - 0.700208
0.467911
59.22
M-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
The location of
g.
for
EE
= 65.354. The pressure distribution and line of action of earth force P
EE
for = 65.354 is shown on the following page. A pressure distribution must
be assumed for the lateral force due to V since only the location of the
resultant force is known. The pressure distribution will be defined by an
isosceles triangle with the apex located at the point of application of the
resultant force due to V . See example 10 of this appendix for the computation of the lateral force due to a surcharge by the elastic method.
M-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
h.
for
EE
= 74.5778. The pressure distribution and line of action of earth force
P
for = 74.5778 is shown on the following page:
EE
M-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
i. Conclusion. For a cohensionless soil when calculating from Equations 3-28, 3-29 and 3-30, the unit weight of soil () in the strip surcharge
(V) term should be the average effective unit weight (
).
should be
avg
avg
calculated using the moist unit weight above the water table and the buoyant
unit weight below the water table.
M-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-5.
EXAMPLE 5.
a.
Estimate
M-21
= 40:
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-tan 8 +
2cd
- .!. +
--=---=--::--:y (h + d )
m
c
2 ( 0 4)
0.12(24.77)
--------~A~-----=--= -----0~.2~6~9-1~4-------
0.4/0.12
0.524135(0.851635)
2(0.4)
0.12(25.47)
4(0.4) (1/4)
0.12(25.47)
0.261746
7 4 7 ft
0.261746
0.50
- .!. +
4
Let
2(0.4)
0.12(25.47)
0.261746
0.044875
a= 30:
0.4/0.12
0.5(0.866025)
~~,:.-;....:::-7--:,....=..=...........,...
7.70 ft
M-22
= 0.071125
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2(0.4)
A= 0.12(25.70)
0.259403
- i + 0.259403
0.259403
Let
0.036249
a= 29:
0.4/0.12
0.484810(0.874620)
2(0.4)
0.12(25.86)
0.5 ,
c1
tan
0.257798
-i +
c2
-1 ( cl
7.86 ft
0.257798
0.030248
0.257798
~~i + 4c2)
a = 29 (nearest degree),
= 29.01
7.86 ft
tan a
K ( tan a - tan
1.00
1 00 (0.554309)
0.304309
M-23
1. 8215
29 (see
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Kb
PEE
= 18 ft,
= 10 ft,
2.5773
7.86 ft
(1/2)(1.8215)(0.12)(0.14)
+ (1/2)(10)[2(1.8215)(0.12)(0.14)
+ 2.5773(0.0625)(10)]
1.6414
KSF
M-24
8.362 k/ft
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
d~) +
2
o.o6(h tan a - tan
3.3333
sin a cos a
sin a cos a
h L
0 _25
tan a
'
3.125 k/ft
W tan a - cd L/cos a - Pw
a= 28:
3.3333
0.469472(0.882948)
8.04 ft,
9.96
0.882948(0.281709)
40.0427 ft
0.06(259.3584)
0.25
0.281709
+ 0.531709
55.7098(0.531709)
PEE
259.3584
55.7098 k/ft
0.4(40.0427)/0.882948 - 3.125
8.356 k/ft
M-25
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Let
a= 29:
3.3333
0.484810(0.874620)
0.06(262.2204) +
0.25
0.304309
0.554309
PEE
PEE
Let
10.14
0.87462(0.304309)
262.2204 ,
7.86 ft
52.1525 k/ft
8.360 k/ft
>
8.356
30:
3.3333
0.5(0.866025)
7.70 ft,
10.30
0.866025(0.327350)
0.06(264.71) + 0.25
0.327350
0.57735
PEE
PEE
264.71
36.3324 ft
48.9517 k/ft
8.356 k/ft
<
8.360
38.0981 ft
~~~-----
M-26
PEE
8.360 k/ft
----------------
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
which agrees with the pressure coefficient solution.
d.
Conclusion.
M-27
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-6.
EXAMPLE 6.
a.
Calculate
M-28
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-1
First trial:
= 39 ,
va
-2.4178
A'
0.242665- 2(-2.4178)(1.058886)
2
0. 5042(10)
A'
0.344219
c'
A'
4C-2.4178)(i)c1.o58886)
2
c' '"' ----------;::---;:-~::-:0~..:...5.:...04..:....:2:....:(~1..:...0:...)- - 1
0.344219
2(0.242665)
0.440486
2V
c'2
M-29
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.242665(1 - 0.242665
c'
2
c;
l)- l
2(-2.4178)(~)(1.058886)
0.5042(10)
0.344219
=
0. 184077
[G-30]
Second trial:
A'
= 33 , y' = 0.5249 ,
0 242665 - 0.021178(-4.2911)
0.5249
0.117773 - 0.007059(-4.2911)
0.5249
va
-4.2911
0.415797
c'
1
-------=o-.-;-41::-:5'""'7'""'"9-=7~:.....:....::..---
o. 4 2203 5
c'
0 066814 + 0.000588(-4.2911)
0.5249
-------=-o-.4.,-,1:-:5:-::7-=-9=-7.:...:::..::....:....::..___
o. 14 912 8
b.
Calculate
2 tan
~d
2(0.466308)
0.932616
tan 8
1 - tan ~d 1 tan 8 - tan ~d
(1/3)
1 - 0.466308(1/3) - 0.466308
M-30
[3-26]
[3-27]
0.129729
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
Wedge 1:
K1
1 - 0.466308(0.947407)
1 + 0.466308(1.055513)
= 0. 374091
1.055513) = 0.5468
= 0.374091 ( 0.
722180
Wedge 2:
K1
= 1 - 0.242665(1.539865)
1 + 0.242665(0.649408)
0 541063
= 0.541063 ( 0.649408)
= 0.7279
0 482741
K = 0.541063(0.649408)
v
d.
= 0.3514
Wedge 1:
h
hl
(tan 8 - tan 8 )
2
1
2
(tan a2 - tan 82)
(lo)(~ -
!)
PEEl=
(0.5468)(0.12)(16.452)
M-31
= 8.88
k/ft
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.5468(0.12)(16.452)
1.0795
Wedge 2:
Treat weight of ABCD as a strip surcharge on Surface BD.
~ (13 + 16.452)(20.715)(0.12)
36.606 k/ft
1
y
(0.7279)(0.13)(10)
4.73 k/ft
K V
0.3514(36.606)
12.86 k/ft
4.73 + 12.86
0.12(13)
0.7279pVD
1.56 ksf
17.59 k/ft
vertical pressure at
1.1355 ksf
M-32
horizontal pressure at
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-33
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
A free body of Block ABCD is shown below.
M
M
= 0
M-34
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-7. EXAMPLE 7. Find the lateral earth force and pressure distribution on
Surfaces FG and HI when: = 35, c = 0 , = 0.12 kcf, and SMF = 2/3 .
a.
Driving side:
(1) Assume that the critical slip plane intersects Surface BC. = 0 ,
h = h = 30 ft. The weight of the triangular area CEF will be taken as a
E
negative strip surcharge. V = -(1/2)(0.12)(6)(2) = -0.72 k/ft
M-35
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
This shows that the critical slip plane does not intersect Surface BC.
(2) Assume that critical slip plane intersects Surface AB. tan
= -(1/3) , h = h = 36 ft. The weights of areas BDE and CEF will be taken as
D
a negative strip surcharge.
M-36
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2(-7.2)(1.217443)
466308 _
0.12(36) 2
0.579034
2
2(0.466308)
4(-7.2)(-
~)(1.217443)
2
0.12(36)
0.579034
0.621268
0.466308[1 - 0.466308
(- .!.) + 2(-7.2)()(1.217443)
(- .!..)]3
3
0.12(36) 2
0.579034
1. 484537
33.69
<
<
59.036
This shows that critical slip plane does intersect Surface AB.
(3)
1 =
K (
tan a
)
tan a- tan 8
1 - 0.466308(0.637733)
1 + 0.466308(1.568054)
0 405858 (1.568054)
1.901387
M-37
0.405858
0.334707
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Kv
K tan
Py =
i K 1 yh~ = i (0.334707)(0.12)(36) 2
KV
0.636407(-7.2)
0.405858(1.568054)
a.
26.027 k/ft
-4.582 k/ft
26.027 - 4.582
0.636407
21.445 k/ft
(4) The net horizontal pressure at point F must be equal to zero, the
negative pressure due to P
cancels the positive pressure due to Py .
v
0.334707(0.12)(8)
0.3213 ksf,
2P
P.
(di~tribution
length for
pvF
=-
-0.3213 ksf
2(-4.582)
-0.3213
28.52 ft
__ .,
__ _..
FI
II
KSF
KSF
~
b.
(1)
COMBINED
Resisting side:
Calculate the critical slip plane angle
tan 6
- 4 ,
tan
<P
0.466308
M-38
a.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
A = 0.466308
From Equation 3-36
2
2 tan
c1 =
A
<f>d
2(0.466308)
0.466308
2
0.932616
c2
i)] + (- i)
=
0.347297
15.91r
[3-35]
= K (
tan a
)
tan a - tan 8
1 + 0.466308(3.506578)
1 - 0.466308(0.285178)
285178)
3.039316 ( 00.535178
0
M-39
3.039316
1.619547
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-40
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-8.
EXAMPLE 8.
a.
= 30,
-1
= tan
tan
= 0.383864.
(1) Since the tan for Surface BE is 0.5 which is greater than
tan , the critical slip plane will not intersect BE. Assume that the slip
d
plane intersects Surface AB:
M-41
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.383864- 2(-122.88)(1.147352)
2
0.12(64)
0.957540
2 tan
c1
<l>d
A
2(0.383864)
0.957540
c1
2
0.307771
c2
0.383864
0.957540
0.400886
ct
33.69 <a< 45, assumption that slip plane intersects Surface AB is correct.
(2)
K tan a
Py
1 - 0.383864(1.241485)
1 + 0.383864(0.805487)
0.399816(0.805487)
0.322047
t Kyh 2 t (0.399816)(0.12)(64) 2
=
M-42
0.399816
98.26 k/ft
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
P
EE
+ P
(3) The net pressure at point E must be equal to zero. The negative
pressure due to P
cancels the positive pressure due to P .
v
P
P
E
vE
M-43
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~
b.
0 ,
= 0.6
ksf,
cd 2/3 ,
c 0.4 ksf.
(1) Assume that the vertical crack extends upward from the critical slip
plane to intersect Surface BE.
tan
e-
0.5
= hE
... 32 ft
tan a
tan a - tan
~d
tan a)
tan a
tan a - tan
tan a
tan a - tan
tan a
tan a - tan
3.333 ft
0.4/0.12
sin a cos a sin a cos a
Assume that
a=
45, then
de=
0 ~~
= 6.667
2cd
= --,,_~~..y(h
+ dc )
M-44
ft
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
A
2(0.4)
0.12(38.667)
0.172412
c1
4(0.4)(0.5)
0.12(38.667)
0.172412
= 1.00
- tan 8 +
2cd
----,.,,..---=-:'"'"'"7""
y(h
d )
c
2(0.4)
-0. 5 + 0.12(38.667)
0.172412
-1.900030
The term under the radical in Equation 3-25 will be negative. This makes a
in~eterminate, so the assumption that the crack intersects Surface BE is not
correct.
(2)
tan 8
Again assume
hd = 64 ft,
h
a
6.667 ft
M-45
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2(0.4)
2(-122.88)
A - 0.12(70.667) - 0.12(4051.55)
Y(h 2cd
+de)
0.599825
/A 2(0.4)
- 0.12(70.667)
0.599825
0.157278
[3-25]
Let
a = 21.63 ,
3.333
0.342655
9.727 ft
2(0.4)
_
2(-122.88)
0.12(73.727)
0.12(4001.39)
c1 = 0
a = tan
Let
_
2(0.4)
c2 - 0 . 12 ( 73 727 )
-1 (c1 +
2(0.4)
A= 0.12(73.893)
c1 = 0 '
~ci + 4c 2)
2
a= 21.18 ,
0.602246
0.602246 = 0.150144
_
- 21.18 # 21.63
3.333
0.336893
9.893 ft
2(-122.88)
0.12(3998.13)
2(0.4)
_
c2 - 0.12( 73 893 )
0 602460
0.602460 = 0.149754
M-46
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Let
a= 21.15 ,
3.333
0.336506
2(0.4)
0.12(73.90)
2(-122.88)
0.12(3997.99)
2(0.4)
0.12(73.90)
a= 21.15 ,
9.90 ft
0.602469
0.602469
0.149737
9.90 ft
96'
<.0
Assume that the crack intersects the sloping surface to the left of
point A.
tan B = -
Let
3 '
96 ft,
-i (0.12)[(64)(32) + (96)(32)]
3.333
= 7.70 ft
0.433013
M-47
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2V
y(h + d )
c
2(0.4)
2(-307.20)
0.12(103.70) - 0.12(9156.71)
0.623441
4V tan B
+ d ')
c
y(h
d~)
4(0.4)(- })
4(-307.20)(- })
0.12(103.70) - 0.12(9156.71)
0.623441
-0.666666
2V tan 2 B
d~)
- (- i)
2(0.4)
+ 0.12(103.7) +
0.623441
1
2 ( -307. 20)(-9 )
0.12(9156.71)
M-48
0.538132
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Let
3.333
de = 0.386256 = 8.63 ft
= 25.29 ,
2(0.4)
2(-307. 2 )
A= 0.12(104.63) - 0.12(9141.52)
~)
4(0.4)(-
0.623799
~)
4(-307.2)(-
0.12(104.63) - 0.12(9141.52)
0.623799
Let
- (-
~) +
o. 1 ~ ~~a!~ 6 3) +
25.25 ,
de
3.333
0.385812 = 8.64 ft
~)
4(-307.2)(-
0.623803
~)
0.12(104.64) - 0.12(9141.35)
0.623803
1)
= 0.536741
0.623799
4(0.4)(-
e2
-0.666666
2(-307.2)(!)
o. 12 c9141. 52)
2(0.4)
2(-30 7 2 )
A= 0.12(104.64) - 0.12(9141.35)
e1
- (- 3 +
= 25.246
-0.666666
2(-307 .2)(!)
2 ( 0 4)
0.12(104.64)
0.623803
25.25 '
M-49
+ --=-~~-:-;--:;---'-;;~
0.12(9141.35)
= 8.64 ft
= 0.536726
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(4)
1 - 0(2.120303)
1 + 0(0.471631)
=1
K1
tan a
)
(0.471631)
K ( tan a - tan B = 1 0.804964 = 0 585903
K tan a
1(0.471631)
0.471631
268.29 k/ft
KV
v
+ p
0.471631(-307.2)
- 144.89 k/ft
268.29 - 144.89
123.40 k/ft
pyE
0.585903(0.12)(64- 8.64)
pvE
-3.8923 ksf
3.8923 ksf
M-50
2(-144.89)
-3.8923
74.45 ft
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
8.64' =de
6.1421
KSF
COMBINED
M-51
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-9.
EXAMPLE 9.
M-52
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-c
= [ 2(0.217443)
- 4(2.4)(0.4)(1.217443)] . 0.344564
2
0.12(20)
0.979471
- tan
~d
tan S) - tan S +
2v tan
s (1 +
yh
0,466308(1- 0,466308
0.4) - 0,4 +
tan
~drj
-2 ~<2~~4~)(~0~~16~)~(~1~,2~1~7~44~3~)]
2
0.12(20)
0.344564
-0.003454
b.
_ (c +
= tan 1 1
~c~ + 4c 2)
2
= 44.302
= 0.3589
1 - 0.466308 x 1.024667
1 + 0.466308 x 0.975927
M-53
[3-25]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-54
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
M-55
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
-=-5. :. .8;;...:;5:...::6~0~(o~:...:,9~77
5 9::-.:2::-::7:-:-=--......:oo--::~4~66::-.:3~0:...::8..!...)
1 + 0.466308(0.975927)
2.051 k
w=
= W=
2
yhCE
1
(tan
a_
tan
B)+
2
(0.12)(10)(4)
2
2
0.12(20)
2(0.975927 - 0.4) + 2.4
= 44.0719 k
- 0.466308)
= 44.0719(0.975927
= 15.435 k
1 + 0.466308(0.975927)
Calculate pressures at C, D, and E.
Pc
2PBC
2(0.345)
hBC =
4
- p
- p
= 0.1725 ksf
1.4599 ksf
M-56
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-57
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-10.
EXAMPLE 10.
M-58
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
tan ~d
0.466308
A
= -=-o.;....,.3~6-=-=89:::....;1~3
1.264005
[3-25]
a =
1 - tan ~d cot a
1 + tan ~d tan a
0.4013
K tan a
= -12 Kyh 2
p
(total)
0.4013(1.858833)
1
0.7459(3)
X
X
0.537972
1.858833
0.7459
(0.4013)(0.12)(25)
KV
p
1 - 0.466308
1 + 0.466308
15.05 k
2.24 k
15.05 + 2.24
17.29 k
M-59
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-60
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
z , ft
2q
1.25
0.3183
2.50
p , ksf
Hz
0.4036
75.96
0.239
0.3183
0.5932
63.43
0.296
5.00
0.3183
0.6316
45.00
0.201
7.50
0.3183
0.5570
36.69
0.113
10.00
0.3183
0.4773
26.57
0.064
12.50
0.3183
0.4107
21.80
0.039
15.00
0.3183
0.3574
18.43
0.025
17.50
0.3183
0.3150
15.95
0.017
20.00
0.3183
0.2808
14.04
0.012
22.50
0.3183
0.2530
12.53
0.008
25.00
0.3183
0.2298
11.31
0.006
, rad
M-61
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Pressure diagram-elastic method.
The force, due to the surcharge, determined by the approximate method is more
severe. It will be combined with the backfill force to obtain the total force.
M-62
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Combined pressure diagram and force:
BACKFILL
COMBINED
M-63
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
M-11.
EXAMPLE 11.
= 0.12 k/ft
(moist weight)
3
= 0.0625 k/ft
3
= 0.125 k/ft
= 35 ,
(buoyancy weight)
(saturated weight)
c = 0
Seismic coefficients:
k = 0.20
H
k = 0
v
M-64
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a.
cp -
1 + ~ tan
c1
~)
2(0.700208- 0.2)
1 + 0.2(0.700208)
cp
= 0.877526
[3-57]
c2
0. 700208 ( 1 - 0. 700208
0.700208(1 + 0.2
= tan -1 (c1 +
1 - tan p cot a
1 + tan cp tan a
0.12763
K (
1)- (1 + 0.2)
0.700208)
::: 0 00431 5
tan a
)
tan a - tan 8
[3-56]
1- 0.700208(1.133240)
1 + 0.700208(0.882425)
0.12763 (-
\O.
0 882425
1) = 0.2051
882425 - 3
[3-54]
(see Appendix H)
[3-69]
M-65
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
PA
~ (0.2051)(0.12)(13) 2 + ~ (12)[2(0.2051)(0.12)(13)
+ 0.2764(0.0625)(12~
PA
~p
7.16 k
- k
AE -
ws
b.
2 (tan a - tan B)
(y
2
- y)h ]
2 tan a
2
2
0.12(25)
0.005(12) ]
0 2 [ 2(0.549092) + 2(0.882425)
6
PAE
-n [
yh
l2
h2
w s
l2
(0.0625)(12) 2
[3-71]
13.74 k
4.50 k
[3-70]
tan
2(0.700208- 0.2)
1 + 0.2(0.700208)
0. 877526
[3-60]
c2
tan (1 + ~ tan )
c2
0.700208- 0.2
0.700208(1 + 0.2 x 0.700208)
a = tan
-1(-c1 +
0.626618
M-66
[3-59]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
!)>
1 + 0.700208(2.144605)
1 - 0.700208(0.466286)
cot a
tan a
<P
<P
3.7144
Pp
21
KPybh
21
(3.7144)(0.0625)(6)
4.18 k
2
2
)
[ 0.125(6) ]
ysh
(
2
0
~ 2 tan a =
2(0.466286) = 0 97 k
ws
c.
= ~ y
w s -
1
2
2 (0.0625)(6)
1.13 k
[3-74]
- 2
18 1
25 1
0.15
12 1
19 1
0.15
w=
y
~w =
67.50
-17.10
50.40 k
524.50
50.40
0.2(50.40 k)
12.50 1
18.67 1
10.41 ft
10.08 k
M-67
843.75
-319.25
524.50
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d.
M-68
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Mononobe-okabe force and pressure distribution--resisting side.
and P
(on the preceding page) are comP
PE
bined, negative pressure will be obtained for some distance below the top of
ground. Since earth pressure can not pull on the wall, the pressure diagram
and force should be determined by setting all negative pressures to zero.
If the pressure diagrams for
M-69
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX N
STABILITY, BEARING CAPACITY, AND REINFORCEMENT COMPUTATIONS, EXAMPLES
SUMMARY OF EXAMPLES
cp = 35
c = 0
cp = 28", c
cp = 0 , c
=0
(DRAINED)
KSF (UNDRAINED)
= 0.9
cp = 35"
c = 0
----------:;;:--Q
~~- 40
= 2.5
KSF
N-1
cp ==
0.9 KSF
==
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
'Q
TOP OF WAVE~
cf>
c
= 20
= 0.4
KSF
c/>=0
c = 0.9 KSF
cf>= 20
c = 0.4 KSF
N-2
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
STABILITY, BEARING CAPACITY, AND REINFORCEMENT COMPUTATIONS, EXAMPLES
EXAMPLE 1. Analyze the wall shown below for stability and bearing
capacity. Find the reinforcement required at critical
sections. Load Case R1.
N-1.
Given:
Backfill:
Foundation:
= 0.120 kcf,
= 0.135 kcf,
Reinforced concrete:
= 35,
= 40,
c = 0
c = 0
= 0.150 kcf,
f = 4 ksi, f = 48 ksi
c
y
All concrete cover = 4.5 in. (to center of gravity
of steel)
Load factor = 1.9,
N-3
= 0.9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a.
(1)
= 40,
SMF
= 2/3 ,
~d
= tan
(2/3 tan
~)
13.5'
.:?ff~
hAs
3 tan ~ 1
26;5 + - - -
tancx2
. 1
=26.5+-tan cx2
(.)
..c::
II
Lo
y'
va
2(0.12)(26.5)
2 (0 .12) (1/3)
+ 0.135 +
tan a
3
2
r 1h 22
(tan s
- tan S )
2
2
2 (tan a2- tan s2)
1
[G-25]
2.255 +
0.08
tan a2
[G-26]
N-4
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
va
y'
2.255 +
1.~9~~63
0.18
(1.697663)
2.302 ,
0.0625
term}~
A'
A'
0.554309- 2(0.0625)(1.307259)
2
2.302(3)
ct
2(0.554309)
0.546422
term)
1.12462
c
term)
N-5
0.546422
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
tan
~d(1
-tan
~d
2Va tan
tan 82)- tan 82 +
82 (1 + tan
'h2
y
~d)
c'2 --------------------------~--------------~--------A
c2 0.554309
0.546422 1.01443
[G-30]
Let
59.73,
y' 2.302 ,
va ... 0.061
ci - 0.554309
0.546611 = 1.124231
0.546611
1.014083
(close enough)
(2)
Backfill:
hAB 26.5 +
3 tan 8
1
t
27.083 ft,
an a
~ =
35
tan
~d
tan
c 1 2 tan
-1
~d
(2/3 tan
~) =
25
2(0.466308) 0.932616
N-6
[3-26]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b.
(1)
1 -
0.466308(~)-
c.
0 . 4 6308
0.129729
46.55
[3-25]
1 - tan
~d
cot a
1 + tan
~d
tan a
1 - 0.466308
1 + 0.466308
(2)
X
X
1
1
0.947307
1.055624
1.055624
1.055624-
31
0.5468
Foundation:
1 - tan
~d
cot a
1 + tan
~d
tan a
2
2
1 - 0.554309
1 + 0.554309
X
X
0.582949
1.715416
0.3470
0.5952
24.06 kips
N-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Surface DE:
=!
PDE
=!
(0.347)(0.135)(3)
=5.623 kips
+ 0.5952(5.623)
Pn
=h- -
2PDE
2(3.5576) - 1.1035
3
pE = 1.2683 ksf
N-8
3.5576 kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d.
N-9
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
e.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
f.
v=2.67 K/FT-........
20.00'
(
PoE :;: 3.56K/FT
:;:
:::-+----
SOIL RESISTANCE
ON SURFACE IJ
NEGLECTED.
~----------
...........~----:::- r:::::;:====-ry:-;;-;-;;rllx
0.5698
KSF
5.0713
KSF
53.400 ft-kips
514.878 ft-kips
135.876 ft-kips
X
-24.06
- 3.56
-27.62
X
X
11.83
1.47
f.H
-284.630
-5.233
414.291 = f.M
= 414.291
56.41
7.34 ft
T ~
r.v
56.41 kips,
r.H
27.62 kips
N' tan cp + cL
FS
[4-12]
N-11
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
27.62
27.62
FS
31.56
tan-1(27 .62)
= 26 0 = 0.4538 rad
56 41
e =
2- xR =
20
-z-
B = B - 2e
qo
t,;
q1
(1
2.66 ft
20 - 2(2.66)
-~r
90
~)2
64.20 ,
14.68 ft
0.405 ksf
YD = 0.135(3)
f,;Yi = (1 -
Nq
7.34
[5-8a]
0.5057
(1 -
z~Y
NY= 93.69
[5-Sa]
0.1225
(Table 5-1)
Q =
(Figure 5-1(a))
t,;Yi BYNy)
B( t,; q iq 0 Nq + ---:::"2
N-12
[5-Sb]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
A 0.25
pmin S p S pmax
is satisfied:
(paragraph 9-8b(3))
pi
200/fy 200/48,000 0.00417 (paragraph 9-8b(4), from ACI 318)
mn
The reinforcement ratio
pb
0.003
d
C is
C to
T yields
o.85f~ba 1 cb - pbbdfy
0.85f'
pb -
s1
0.85 ,
cb
81 T
0.85f~
t
c - 0.003
61
(
c
I
+ 29,000
ksi)
N-14
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.85(4) (0 85) (
48
pmax
0.003
)
48
0 003 + 29,000
0.009700
0.25(0.03880)
0.00417
<
0.03880
p = 0.008307
<
0.009700
Ductility is adequate.
Reinforcement in heel at face of stem.
j.
2.67
35.28
5.40
-23.05
12'
~
-J:.c
_co
"
10
6.16'
ot\!
12.00
6.16
6.00
4.59
X
X
=
M = 175.96 k-ft
(I)~
ij
::..
32.04
217.32
32.40
-105.80
Mu
$ =
_ _ _ _ _ __,~h
= 3' =36"
= 12 in.,
4.59'
1.9(175.96)(12)
0.9
0.425f'bd
c
0.5698
KSF
3.2711
KSF
23.05K
BRG. PRESS.
1 -
cu
Tu
Check ductility:
max
0.009700 ,
= 20,241.9
~1
4 458
20,241.9
= 0.1170
= 0.85(4)(0.1170)(12)(31.5)
150.37 kips
A
= 4 , 458 k-in.
p .
m1n
0.00417
N-15
150 37
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Ductility is adequate.
k. Reinforcement in toe at face of stem.
Check ductility:
Ductility is adequate.
N-16
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
31.5 -
1. 5
29.5 in.
2"2
1.06818 d
2.46 ft
31.5
(22 - 2.46)
2
(22)
vu
2
(24.06) = 18.98 kips
~v
V c
(0.85)(2) If' bd
c
(0.85)(2)14,000(12)(29.5)
38,061 lb > v
Check the shear capacity of the heel at the base of the stem:
V = 2.67 + 5.40 + 35.28 - 23.05 = 20.3 kips
vu
~v
~v
1.9 (20.3)
38.57 kips
(0.85)(2) If' bd
c
N-17
40,642 lb >
vu
above
can be
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-2.
EXAMPLE 2.
a.
(1)
N-18
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2
3
PHD
1.67 ksf
0.3439(4.68)- 2(0.5865)(1.67)
-0.3495 ksf
Backfill:
SMF
2(0.466308)
0.932616
[3-26]
tan B
1 - tan ~d tan B - tan ~d
[3-27]
1 - 0.466308
tan-1
6-
0.466308
0.564864
(c_1_+_~-..,...;
2_1_+_4_c_2) 53 4 9"
1 - tan
~d
cot a
1 + tan
~d
tan a
1 - 0.466308
1 + 0.466308
X
X
tan a
tan a - tan S
0.740231
1.350929
[3-25]
(see Appendix H)
1.350929
1.350929 -
61
N-19
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-20
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
1.75KSF
1.00
KSF
u.i-----1-------t
(f.)
::.c
WATER
WATER
,..:1....----........-~
U=45.72K
17.898 KSF
BEARING PRESSURE
XR
207.61 kips
-45.72 kips
161.89 kips
= EV
=6.030'
= EH
976.23
N-21
161.89 = 6.030 ft
XR
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
18.09 ft.
>
50%
N'
T ;:;;
1:V
161.89 kips,
N' tan
cp
FS
;:;;
+ cL
[4-12]
68.27
FS
tan-
e =
B=
(~~) =
B
zXR =
B - 2e
( 1 ~~:~~)
15 - 6.030
30 - 2(8.970)
y'
0.0775 kef,
y'D
tan-
8.970 ft
6 ft
N-22
[5-8a]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~cd
~cd =
1 + 0.2(0.4975)(2.1445)
~qd
~yd
~)
[5-4a]
1.213
~) =
1.107
[5-4c]
[5-5a]
0)
~yi = ( 1 - ~
= 75.31 ,
2
(.1 - ~
22 87)
2
=
64.20
[5-5b]
0.1834
93.69
(Table 5-1)
[5-2]
Q = 12.060[1.213(0.5564)(2.5)(75.31)
+ 1.107(0.5564){(h465)(64.2)
+ 1.107(0.1834)(12.~60)(0.0775)(93.69)]
1861.41 kips
Fs
g_
N'
EV
1861.41
161.89
N'
The
11.50
>
FS
2.0
N-23
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-3.
EXAMPLE 3.
0.5' 1.5'
12'
A
RIVERSIDE
6'
LANDSIDE
-+------+ -----;~.'-------H,::~;
WT. OF CONCRETE,
WATER & SOIL
_.ABOVE CDEG___.-
~~:
:- .. .
11.12'
~~:
:<.o'
.;
~
....
I
PARA. 7-6.
ASSUMED
CRACK TO
BOTTOM OF
KEY.
N-24
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a.
20.4 ft + 5 ft
25.4 ft
Dist. below
Headwater
it
Dist. below
Headwater
9(20.4)
25.4
L = 1.5 + 4.03 + 18
8
D
= 2 ~:; 3
= 23.53
(7.228)
(18 - 0.4608)0.0625
Head loss at
1.125 ksf
7.228 ft
LS (Concrete surface)
Head loss at
0.4232 ksf
CG
9 0) 0~0625
~8 ft - 25.4
ft
0.4608 ft
1.0962 ksf
(14 - 1.699)0.0625
0.7688 ksf
N-25
1. 699 ft
Total
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b.
Overturning calculations
N-26
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
(1)
25.31K
11.12'
SOIL BELOW
CONCRETE~
""-3.99K ...,.._-J--J--1_2._15_'_, H
~._--------T--~~--~~--------~~
4.
til'
WATER
1. 125
KSF
u=
15.4s"
LeG= 20.4'
0.9 x 20.4
N' tan
<P
18.36 kips
+ cL
FS
[ 4-12]
FS
is 1.5.
3.15
~ ~:; 6
3.15
12.24
N-27
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(2)
On Plane CF:
N-28
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
y'
[9 ft(0.12) - 0.7371] 9
Undrained condition,
c = 0.9 ksf
cd
SMF(c)
cd
1.0
(0.9)
[3-10]
0.6 ksf
(0.0381)(9)
1.54 kips
N' tan cb + cL
FS
~~~~--~
FS
[4-12]
6.82 - 1.54
5.28 kips
12
5.28 ~ 1.5
5.28
N-29
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
SMF =
tan 4>d
tan
= -32
4>
[3-10]
19.52
Let K
1/2 K
PR =
t Kybh2 = t (1.385)(0.0381)(9) 2
N'
~v
2.14 kips
15.51
4.68 kips
FS
[4-12]
4.68 ~
15.51 tan 28
1.5
4.68
5.50
N-30
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
3.15 kips
LCG
20.4
e=-2-- a = -2- - 7.79
= LCG -
tan-
2e
15.58 ft
(~)
tan-
= 5 ft
= y'D
Ct~~) =
2.41
12.02
0.0575 kef
1 + o.2(i)
(for
cp
[5-8a]
00)
E;yd
E;qd
E;yd
1 +
E;qd
~yd
1 + 0.1( : )(1.6643)
15 58
E;
i;
. = (1
C1
. = (1 Y1
0.1(~)
-_l
90
2
12.02)
28
[5-4a]
= 1 + 0.2 ( 15 : 58 ) = 1.064
E;qd
q1
(Figure 5-1)
[5-4b]
!)
tan (45 +
(for
1.053
cp
28)
[5-4c]
28)
2
( 1 _ 12 g2)
0.3257
0.7507
[5-Sa]
[5-5b]
N-31
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~qt
~yt = (1 -
~ ct
1 -
a tan
(~)
~ + 2
~) 2 = (1 - 0.197
0 394
1 - ( ~ + 2 ) = 0.9232
0.532)
(for
"'
~
= 0.8015
=
0)
[5-6a]
[5-6b]
Undrained condition:
c 0.9 ksf
From Equation 5-2
= 5.14
= 1.00
(Table 5-1)
Q- 15.58G.o64(0.7S07)(0.9232)(5.14)(0.9) + 1(0.7507)(0.8015)(0.2875)(18
Qr = 55.84 kips,
FS
Q
55.84
=NT=
14 79 = 3.78
>
3.00
(Table 4-2)
Drained condition:
Q=
B~
~ ~ q N +
qd qi qt 0 q
N 14.72 ,
q
~ yd ~ yi ~ yt
= 11.19
BN)
y y
(Table 5-1)
Q- 1S.s8G.o53(0.7507)(0.801S)(0.2875)(14.72)
N-32
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Fs = g_
N'
63.24
_
14 79
(Table 4-1)
f'
3 ksi,
(1)
At base of stem:
40 ksi,
cover
4.5 in.
M = 4.5
M
$u
= 18.00 k-ft
12 in.
1 -
J
0. 75
KSF
Tu
s
y- =
0.85f'k bd
23.87
I$
0.425f'bd
c
1 -
~1
0.85(3)(0.040)(12)(19.5)
c u
456.0
5817.825
23.87 kips
2
0.60 in. /ft
B1
0.85 '
pb
0.85f'
c
f
y
B{
0.003
c
f
:~(see
+ 29,000 ksi
N-33
example 1, paragraph i)
(Figure 9-2)
0.0400
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
0.8~63)
0.003 40 ) = 0.03712
0
003
\
+ 29,000
(0.85) (
Pmax
pmax
0.25(0.03712
0.000928
200/40,000 ksi
A
0.60
= bd = 12(19.5)
0.002564
Instead of using pmin , ACI 318 allows the minimum area of reinforcement to be
one-third greater than that required by analysis.
Therefore,
2
A = 4/3(0.60) = 0.80in. /ft
s
s
0.80
p = bd = 12(19.5)
0.00342
P = pmax
Ductility is adequate.
(2)
19.5 - 0.0333 d
19.5
1.03333
18.87 in.
1.573 ft
N-34
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
=!2
~v
3.40 kips
~V
(0.0625)(12- 1.573)
~2/f' bd
c
v
6,460 lb
(from ACI-318)
= 2(0.85)(13000)(12)(18.87) = 21,084 lb
> 6,460
3.92K(SOJL + GONG)
~=
~
BRG. PRESS
+UPLIFT
= 0.85(3)(0.03244)(12)(19.5)
As =
Tu
19.36
Check ductility:
pmax = 0.00928 ,
pmin
0.005
s
0.48
p = bd = 12(19.5)
0.00205
N-35
19.5 in.
= 5817.825
f
371.39
1 - ~ 1 - 5817.825
19.36 kips
= 0.03244
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Again, since
required by analysis.
A
s
4/3(0.48)
A
Therefore,
0.64
12(19.5)
s
bd
0.002735
P < Pmax
Ductility is adequate.
(4)
SOIL
WATER+ G O N G . - - - - - 14.5r
5.34'
,;
6.63'
UPLIFT
8.86/(
!<SF
0.5768
3.73'
WATER
14.67 X 6.00
1.05 X 11.10
-8.86 X 6.63
-5.25 X 4. 71
1. 61 kips
-3.73 X 3.12
-5.34 X 3.00
1. 63 X 0.02
4.00 X 3.08
-3.44 kips
M
0.1545 -.:::----~::-+----.
!<SF
0.7200
!<SF
b = 12 in.,
0.425f'bd
5.25'
88.02
11.66
-58.74
-24.73
-11.64
-16.02
0.03
12.32
-0.90 k-ft
h = 24 in.,
5817.825
1.9M
u
u
M
u
20.52
6.54
20.52 in.-k
3.14
N-36
d = 19.5 in.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
d-
Mu
p
2h =
<
19.5-
d -
24
-z
7.5
-20.52 + 6.54(7.5)
28.53 in.-k
A'
M
u
P
p
no"
16.92 ft-k
385.78 in.-k
1.9P
0.9 -
0.9 -
0.90 + 5.34(3.00)
1.9M
2
0.053 in. /ft
40
1.9(1.9)
p
<!>
40(0.053)
Reinforcement at
0.9-
y s
6 54
f A'
u -
28.53
0.9(40)(19.5- 4.5)
ue
<Pf ( d - d')
O.lf 1 bh
c
3.61 kips
(0. 2)
3.61
(0. 2)
0.1(3)(12)(19.5)
0.89
N-37
203.04 in.-k
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
ue
= M
u \
!!_\
2}
~ 4)
412.86 in.-k
1 -
1 - _ _M_u_e--=<P0.425f'bd2
c
1 -
~1
412.86
0.89(5817.825)
0.04070
0.85f'kubd fy
T"u
61
0.85(3)(0.04070)(12)(19.5) - 3
0.89
40
2
0.51 in. ft
Check ductility:
0.00928 '
Pmax
A
p =
b~
12~i~~5)
p i
mn
0.005
0.00218
N-38
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
P < Pmin
A
p
2
0.68 in. /ft
4/3(0.51)
Use A
s
0.68
0.00291
= bd : 12(19.5)
Ductility is adequate.
M
u
0.9
cu
ry
0.02261
0.85(3)(0.02261)(12)(19.5)
Tu
260.11 k-in.
260.11
5817.825
1 - _,j1
13.49
4o
2
0.34 in. /ft
Check ductility:
pmax = 0.00928
A
p =
s
bd
0.34
12(19.5)
10.27 ft-k
pmin
0.005
0.00145
N-39
l3. 49 kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Use
2
A 4/3(0.34) 0.45 in. /ft
s
p < p
max
Ductility is adequate.
N-40
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-4.
EXAMPLE 4.
0.5'
8'
1.5:
6'
~------~------------+~.~-~~ --------~~-----r
~. ~~;
:, ...
+-----+--...----~ -~
T
WATER, SOIL
& CONCRETE
'.
1---H:;--~+-9.3_5_'--~
:.~.:
c
YsAr=0.12KCF
41=0
c=0.9KSF
a.
uC
= 17(0.0625)
1.0625 ksf
16.49 ft
LCD
LDE
= 3 ft
N-41
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
b.
Overturning stability.
N-42
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
On Surface CD:
N' = 9.58 kips,
LCD
T
3.69 kips,
= 14.04,
0 ,
16.49 ft
N' tan p + cL
FS
[4-12]
FS
0~.9~(1_6_._4_9~)
3.69 ~ _9~~58__t_a_n__0~~+__
1.5
0
3.69
9.89
0.245 rad
tan
-1 (TN')
e = L;D-
y'
= 0.9 ksf
sat
- y
-1
3.69
9.58
16249 - 5.78
LCD - 2e
tan
2.465 ft
16.49 - 2(2.465)
= 0.120 - 0.0625
0.0575 kef
N-43
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~cd
Y~
[5-8a]
[5-4a]
rs-4b1
[5-Sa]
yi
=0
qt
[5-Sb]
yt
[5-6a]
= 1
[5-6b]
N = 5.14 ,
c
= 1 ,
= 0 (Table 5-1)
[5-7 a]
2(8)
~cg
= 1 -
Q=
B~<cd<ci<ct<cgcNc)
+
(n
+ 2)
1 -
2(0)
(n
+ 2)
[5-7b]
+ <<qd<qi<qt<qgqoNq)
(~yd~yi~yt~ygByNY)]
[5-2]
= 11.56[(1.05)(0.587)(0.905)(1)(0.9)(5.14)
N-44
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
= 31.00 3 24
Fs = g_
N'
9.58 =
[5-1]
f'
3 ksi,
cover
40 ksi,
load factor
1.9 ,
0.9 ,
4>
= 4.5 in.
12 in.,
23.44 in.,
M = 0.0625(11.5)(
M = 0.0625(11.5)
Mu
~ =
0.0625
11 5
11 5
; ) ( ; )
3 1
15.84 ft-k
1.9(15.84)(12)
0.9
401.28 k-in.
It)
0.425f'bd
5488.471
0.7188 KSF
~1
1 -
401.28
5488.471
cu
T
u
0.85f'k bd
c u
cu
T
u
21.59 kips
A
s
T
u
21.59
N-45
0.03725
pb
for
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
{-
01
:\
pb)
\ 29,000 ksi
0.85(3)(0.85)
40
f- 0.003 )
~ 003 + 29~~00
0.03712
pmax
0.25 pb = 0.00928
s
0.54
Pactual = bd = 12(18.94)
Since
<
0.00238
p =
b~
12 c~8~~ 4 >
o.oo317
Ductility is adequate.
=
N-46
b = 12 in.,
d 36- 4.5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
SOIL + WATER+ CONC.
0.1419
1.1027
KSF
WATER
2.58(2.66)
5.61(2.95)
-3.11(2.96)
0.96(-0.34)
6.863
16.550
-9.206
-0.326
13.881 k-ft
P0
1.9(13.881)
26.37 ft-k
316.44 in.-k
Mue = Mu + Pu(d -
M
~
4>
= 375.98
0.9
0.425f'bd
c
417.75 in.-k
0.425(3)(12)(31.5)
N-47
15,181.425
~) =
375.98 in.-k
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
- Mue
.. 1 -
4>
1
= 1 {1
0.425f'bd 2
'\}
417.75
15,181.425
- 0.01385
cu -
0.85f'k
bd- 0.85(3)(0.01385)(12)(31.5)
c u
cu
13.35 kips T
u
----T
13.35
40
12 ~3~: 5 )
2
0.33 in. /ft
0.000873
<
pmax
= 0.00928
N-48
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
(3)
KSF
0,
0
0.8125
..:
3.75K
(')
,.
1.74K
1.0625
-1.74
11.18
3.75
-2.643
-6.94
KSF
0. f)(i()
KSF
X
X
X
X
X
2.07 = -3.60
4.11 "" 45.95
1.09 = 4.09
-8.62
3.26
4.30 = -29.84
7.98 k-ft
M ""
b = 12 in.,
0.425f'bd
c
= 19.5 in.
- 5817.825
P
P
181.92 in.-k
N-49
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
p
u
= 0 9 - 0.1f'bh (0. 2)
2.6
(0 2)
0 9 - 0.1(3)(12)(24)
0.89
M
ue
-cp-..
Check
201.42
0.89
226.31 in.-k
min
Pmax = 0.25Pb
f p
y max
km = 0.85f 1
c
0.00928
40,000(0.00928)
0.85(3000)
0.14557
dmin
Jo:BSf~k; ~)
(1 _
226.31
7.40 in.
This is an approximate value of
flexure.
hi
mn
= 7.40
+ 4.5
d .
m1n
11.9 in.
N-50
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
k0 = 1 -
1 -
~1
The steel
ue
<P0.425f'bd
c
226.31
5817.825
0.01964
p
0.85f'k bd - T
c u
f
y
't'
0.85(3)(0.01964)(12)(19.5) -
2 60
0.89
40
2
0.22 in. /ft
A
Since
P
A
0.22
= bd = 12(19.5)
<
P .
m1n
0.0009402
< p
m n
0.005
4/3(0.22)
2
0. 29 in. /ft
N-51
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-5.
EXAMPLE 5.
Reference:
N-52
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
pressure
head at F
+ total head differential
( due to position
(6.o + 12.0
21 ~ 25 )co.o625)
0.516 ksf
~;G
(0.0625)
at point F
D - pressure
at
point F)
1.125 - 0.5(1.125 - 0.516)
b.
y'
0.821 ksf
Resisting side:
FJ ~
J~
p
0
1 - sin
1 - 0.342
cp
0.658
(0.658)(0.0273)(4)
[3-4]
2
N-53
0.1437 kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
24.62K
10.11'
WATER
WATER
0.516
I<SF
1.125 KSF
1.4468 KSF
:IV=
r.v
-10.13 X 6.00
0.14 X 1.33
1.41 X 1.87
l:H .,. -8.57 kips
a
24.62 X 10.11
-12.38 X 9.85
12.24 kips
= 3xR
3(5.64)
Percent of base
in compression
248.91
-121.94
-60.78
0.19
2.64
69.02
12.24K
12.24
= 5.64 ft = ~
(!)(100)
b
(161.892)100
94%
>
75%
(Table 4-2)
Criterion is satisfied.
d.
N' =
rv = 12.24
kips,
= EH
8.58 kips
N-54
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
tan <P + cL
T ;:; ; _N' _;;_;,....;...;.,~___;;,-
[4-12]
FS
8.58
FS
e.
EH) =
tan-1( !V
2- XR
B - 2e
18
-z-
tan-1 ( 8.58)
12 24
5.64
3.36 ft
18 - 2(3.36)
11.28 ft
y'
<cd
1 +
0.1(11~28)
35 03 o (Figure 5-1)
(1.428)
4 ft
[5-8a]
~)-
1 +
1.051
N-55
0.2(11 ~ 28 ) (1.428)
1.101
[5-4a]
[5-4c]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
[5-5a]
~yi .. 0 '
0 >
~yg -
~qg ~
~cg
= qg
~ct
qt
- tan (8)] 2
1 -
~qt - ~yt -
- ~
[5-5b]
cj>
qg
tan cj>
1 -
= 14.83 ,
qt
tan cj>
1 - 1
- 14.83 (tan 20 6 )
=1
(1 - a tan
[1 - tan (O)J
2
cj>)
=1 -
= 6.40 ,
(1 - 0)
[5-7d]
[5-6a]
= 1
1 - 1
14.83 (tan 20)
[5-7 a]
[5-6c]
(~Jd~yi~yt~ygByNY)]
[5-2]
(1) (1)
(0.4) (14.83)
+ 1.051(0.373)(1)(1)(0.25)(6.4)
= 12.24
FS = g_ =
N'
34 55
2 82 > 2
12.24
[5-1]
N-56
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-6.
EXAMPLE 6.
1.5'
19.17'
14.50'
WATER,
SOIL & CONC. \_
87.21K
24.20'
<I>= 20
c =0.4 KSF
N-57
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
a.
~38.5) 2
LCF =
42.29 ft,
44.5 (0.0625)
Head loss at
UE
4 ~:~ 6
19.674 ft
~E
LCD +
+ LEF
47.96 ft
0.6153 ft
(19.674)
(34.42- 4.795)0.0625
4.795 ft
1.852 ksf
1 - sin
y'
[5 (0.125)
42.29
_
(22)
47 29
Head loss at
22 ft
L
5
b.
6h
2.7813 ksf
LFG = 5 ft,
LS
uc
+ (17.5)
!2
Ky h
0 b
1 - 0.342
0.4579]
[3-4]
0.658
5
0.0334 kef
2
1
(0.658) (0.0334) (5)
2
= -
N-58
0.275 kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
c.
h
Pw
d.
44.5 ft, w
0.0625 ksf
1 (0.0625)(44.5)2
2
61.88 kips
22.50
-2.67
1.67
-8.75
-10.11
M
xR
536.88
38.62
13.90 ft > b
3
= 165.22
=
0.45
= -251.48
= -332.32
=
536.88 k-ft
N-59
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
e.
0.4579
KSF
2.7813
N'
T
r.v cos a +
f.H
f.H sin (l
cos a - r.v sin a
53.92 kips
44.63 (0.9104) + 32.13 (0.4137)
32.13 (0.9104) - 44.63 (0.4137) = 10.79 kips
1 cF = 42.29 ft
N'
N' tan
N' tan
<P
+ cL
[4-12]
FS
<P
+ cLCF
N-60
= 36.54
kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
FS
required is 1.5.
T <= 36.54
1.5
10.79;:;;; 24.36
Criterion is satisfied.
f.
o=
a= 24.44,
tan-
(~,)
tan-
(;~:~;)
a = 0.427 rad
LCF
2
= -----
42.29
a= ------- 17.65
2
LCF - 2e
5 ft, yb
35.30 ft
42.29 - 2 (3.495)
=
0.0625 ,
~cd
~qd
~yd
~qt
~yt
~ct
sqt
3.495
!)
ybD
[5-Sa]
0.3125 ksf
1 + 0.2(3;. 3 ) (1.428)
1.04
[5-4a]
[5-4c]
(1 - a tan
1 -
qt
N tan~
c
~) 2
(1 -
0.427
0.364)
1 - 0.7133
0 7133 - 14.83
x 0.364
N-61
0.66
0.7133
[5-6a]
[5-6c]
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
~ ci
~qi =
yi
(1
2
o)
(
1 - -~
N = 14.83 ,
c
0
90 )2
11 32)
( 1 - -----20
N = 6.40 ,
q
[5-Sa]
2
=
0 188
N = 2.87
y
[5-Sb]
(Table 5-1)
[5-2]
Q = 35.3[1.04(0.764)(0.66)(0.4)(14.83) + 1.02(0.764)(0.7133)(0.3125)(6.4)
+
FS
1.02(0.188)(0.7133)~35.3)(0.0625)(2.87)].
g_
N'
164 34
53.92
(Table 4-2)
N-62
164 34 kips
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
N-7.
EXAMPLE 7.
15'
5'
AI I+-----4----r----...~
TOP OF WAVE\
~-
:. ~
:-
.:
~:
:I) .~
_,... --=S;:.;.W;.;.;.:;.L;;....,~<a-----t:: ~
....
-~~
t/> = oo
c=0.90 KSF
WATER: Yw=0.064 KCF
10.7(0.064)
Ls
22 + 7
0.0
29 ft
0.237 ksf
= 0.685 ksf
0.505 ksf
uE
N-63
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
2
(6.5 + 7.0) (0.064) -
5.832(13.5)
1
3-
2
(3.7 + 7.0) (0.064)
3.664(10.7)
~:~~~
31
= 5.832-
13.176 ft-k
= 6.077 ft
above point C.
The dynamic force of the breaking wave is calculated from procedures found in
Chapter 7 of the Shore Protection Manual.
Dynamic force of breaking wave
b.
K0
1.00
(at-rest)
Po
=2
KoYb h
7 = 0.0529 kef
2
1
(1.00)(0.0529)(7)
2
= -
1.296 kips
N-64
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
TOP OF WAVE
DYNAMIC FORCE
WAVE
FORCE
5.17f>K
S.W.L.
llSTATIC
2.168K
~
<::)
....
28.61K
"~i-.. 3.665K
'
1.29eK
1010
II)
0.685 KSF
WATER
... ~.:.
-cl
UPl,.IFT
0.685
0.685 KSF
IV =
3.04'
r.V
325.87
-154.98
28 61 X ll 39
-13.36 X 11.60
15.25 kips
-5.176 X 10.700
-2.168 X 6.077
-3.665 X 3.567
1.77 X 2.333
1.296 X 2.333
-7.943 kips
r.H
Percent of base
i n compress i on
15.21f
-55.38
-13.18
-13.07
4.12
3.02
96.40
= 6.32 ft = XR
a = 3xR = 3(6.32) = 18.96 ft
15.25
(Table 4-3)
N' tan p + cL
FS
[4-12]
N-65
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
T = EH = 7.94 kips
FS
7.40
~ --------~~~--~--~
7.40
13.65
= tan-
e =
2B -
(~~)=
xR =
( 1 ;:;~)=
22
z- 6.32
4.68 ft
tan-
B = B - 2e
22 - 2(4.68)
D
q
5.14 '
7 ft,
12.64 ft
yb = y'
y'D = 0.061(7)
{cd- 1 +
E;qd
o.z(~)
0.125 - 0.064
0.061 kef
0.427 ksf
[5-8a]
1 + 0.2 ( 1 / 64 ) - 1.111
[5-4a]
[5-4b]
1.00
[5-Sa]
N-66
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Q=
B(~ c d~ c icN c
~ q d~ q1.q 0 Nq )
Q = 12.64G.lll(0.482)(0.9)(5.14) + 1.00(0.482)(0.427)(1.00)]
Q = 33.91 kips
Using Equation 5-l yields
FS
= g_
= 33
91 = 2.22
N'
15.25
>
1.50
N-67
(Table 4-3)
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
APPENDIX O
COMPUTER PROGRAM ABSTRACTS FOR REFERENCED PROGRAMS
O-1. Computer program abstracts included in Appendix O are: Bearing Capacity
Analysis of Shallow Foundations (CBEAR); CFRAG - Seepage Analysis of Confined
Flow Problems by the Method of Fragments; CSLIDE - Sliding Stability Analysis
of Concrete Structures; Seepage Package; UTEXAS2-University of Texas Analysis
of Slopes-Version 2; An Interactive Graphics Three-Dimensional Geometry Program; CSTR - Concrete Strength Investigation and Design of Hydraulic Structures; Users Guide for Concrete Strength Investigation and Design (CASTR) in
Accordance with ACI 318-83.
O-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CATEGORY A
ELECTRONIC COMPUTER PROGRAM ABSTRACT
CBEAR
TITLE OF PROGRAM
AUTHOR(SI
OA TE PROGRAM COMPLETED
June 1982
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
FINAL
STAGE
OPER
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
This program can be used for the analysis of the bearing capacity of shallow
strip, rectangular, square, or circular foundations on one- or two-layer soil
systems. The bearing capacity can be computed considering the effects of
embedment of the foundation, inclination of the foundation base, inclined
loads, a sloping soil surface, eccentric loads in three dimensions, submerged
soil, or surcharge.
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
c.
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
E.
INPUT-OUTPUT
Data is input from a prepared data file in free field format or from the
If the data are input: from a terminal the
user's terminal during execution.
user may enter data by using key command words or by following a prompting
sequence.
Output from the program may be directed to a file or printed at the
user's terminal.
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
esc
A copy of the program and documentation may be obtained from the Engineering
Computer Programs Library (ECPL), WES, telephone number:
commercial
(601) 634-2581 or FTS 542-2581.
WES
FORM
I
JUl.. 10
2205
O-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CATEGORY A
CFRAG
CFRAG
Seepage Analysis of Confined Flow
PROGRAM NO.
Problems by the Method of Fragments (I0018)
741-F3-R0108
PREPARING AGENCY
us Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Automatic Data
Processing Center, PO Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180
AUTHOR IS)
STATUS OF PROGRAM
Michael E. Pace, Dennis R. DATE PROGRAM COMPLETED
Williams, Thomas F. Wolff, and
PHASE
~STAGE
Reed Mosher
October 1983
OP
TITLE OF PROGRAM
A.
PURPOSE 0 F PROGRAM
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
c.
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
E.
INPUT-OUTPUT
Input - Data may be supplied from a prepared data file or from the user's terIf the data are input from the terminal, the user may
minal during execution.
enter data by using key command words or by following a prompting sequence.
Output
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
A copy of the program and documentation may be obtained from the Engineering
Computer Programs Library, WES; telephone:
(601) 634-2581 or FTS 542-2581.
WES
FORM
1 JUl..
ao
2205
O-5
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CSLIDE
TITLE OF PROGRAM
AUTHOR IS!
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
STAGE
Jul.y 1986
OP
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
This program was devel.oped to assess the sl.iding stabil.ity of concrete structures using the l.imit equil.ibrium method described in the Engineering Technical. Letter (ETL) 1110-2-256.
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
c.
METHODS
D.
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
The program is operational. on the Honeywel.l. DPS-8 CDC Cyber, and Harris 500
computers in the time-sharing mode.
Any ASCII time-sharing terminal may be
used, but i f graphics are desired a Tektronix 4014 terminal. must be used.
E.
INPUT -OUTPUT
Input - Data may be suppl.ied from a prepared data fil.e or from the user's terminal during execution.
I f the data are input: from the terminal., the user may
enter data by using key command words or by following a prompting sequence.
All data are read in free-field format.
Output - An echoprint of the input data and the results of the analysis in
tabular and graphical. form may be obtained.
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
A copy of the program and documentation may be obtained from the Engineering
Computer Programs Library (ECPL), WES; telephone:
(601) 634-2581 or
FTS 542-2581.
This program is designated X0075 in the CORPS Library.
WES
FORM
1 JU L
80
2205
O-7
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
C.
METHODS (Continued)
CSLIDE can compute the factor of safety against sliding considering the
effects of:
a.
b.
c.
d.
h.
i.
0-8
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CATEGORY B
FEMSEEP
TITLE OF PROGRAM
PROGRAM NO.
Fred T. Tracy
A.
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
January 1983
STAGE
OP
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
B.
The driver runs in timesharing and calls X8200 (704-F3-R0006) for grid generation, 704-F3-R00ll for seepage analysis, and X820l (704-F3-R0005) for
post-processing.
c.
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
D.
E.
INPUT-OUTPUT
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
The seepage analysis consists of steady-state solutions to plane or axisymmetric, confined or unconfined, and homogeneous or inhomogenous problems.
Documentation may be obtained from the Engineering Computer Programs Library
(ECPL), WES, telephone number:
commercial (601) 634-2581 or FTS 542-2581.
WES
FORM
t
JUL 80
2205
REPLA.CES
0-9
O-9
IS OBSOl-ETE.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
ELECTRONIC COMPUTER PROGRAM ABSTRACT
TITLE OF PROGRAM
AUTHOR lSI
(See reverse)
A.
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
STAGE
OP
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
c.
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
Microcomputer with a least 512K memory, a hard disk, and a math co-processor.
Time-sharing computer (CDC Cyber. or Harris 500) with Tektronix 4014 terminal
or emulator for graphics.
E.
INPUT -OUTPUT
Input - Data is supplied from a prepared data file which allows for free-field
input and requires command words.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
Graphics capability for displaying the input data and the final shear surface
is available. A copy of the program and documentation may be obtained from
(601) 634-2581 or
the Engineering Computer Programs Library. WES, telephone:
FTS 542-2581.
WES
FORM
.,
JUL
ao
2205
REPLACES
0-11
O-11
OBSOLETE~
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
AUTHOR(S) (Continued).
Dr. Stephen G. Wright-Univ. of Texas, Austin; POC-Earl Edris, Geotech Lab and
Reed Mosher, Information Tech Lab
0-12
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CATEGORY B
3D SAD
TITLE OF PROGRAM
PROGRAM NO.
An Interactive Graphics Three-Dimensional
713-F3-R0008
Geometrv Program (X8100)
PREPARING AGENCY
us Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Automatic
Data Processin2 Center PO Box 631, Vicksburg, MS 39180
AUTHOR lSI
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
October 1978
Fred T. Tracy
A.
OP
TSTAGE
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
B.
c.
METHODS
Use a right handed coordinate system. Solid pieces of the structures may be
described as (1) block - a two-dimensional cross-section extended in the third
direction, (2) an eight node brick element, (3) a cluster of surfaces to form
a solid.
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
D.
E.
INPUT-OUTPUT
Input must be by a basic data file with addition and display commands entered.
Output will be displayed directly on the terminal.
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
Program is available through the CORPS on WES G-635, CSC H600 at Macon, GA,
and Boeing Computer Services.
---
Reports include:
1.
2.
3.
WES
F0A")r.4
I
.JUL. 10
2205
0-13
O-13
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
CATEGORY B
ELECTRONIC COMPUTER PROGRAM ABSTRACT
TITLE OF PROGRAM
AUTHORtSl
c. c.
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
September 1984
ISTAGE
Operational
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
C.
The
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
D.
E.
INPUT -OUTPUT
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
A copy of the program and documentation may be obtained from the Engineering
Computer Programs Library, WES; telephone: (601) 634-2581 or FTS 542-2581.
The User's Guide for this program is WES IR K-84-9.
WES
FO!qM
1 JUt..
eo
2205
O-15
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
TITLE OF PROGRAM
PROGRAM NO.
User 1 s Guide for Concrete Strength Investi713 F3-R0067
o.oot-inn ,.,~ n ...don rr.A~TR) in Accordance with ACI 318-83
PREPARING AGENCY
US Army Engineer Waterways Experiment Station, Information
'rDI"hnnlnav r .. hnr .. t-nrv
PO Box n11 Vicksbun!: MS 39180-0631
AUTHOR lSI
c. c.
w. A.
A.
STATUS OF PROGRAM
PHASE
October 1985
~STAGE
Operational
PURPOSE OF PROGRAM
B.
PROGRAM SPECIFICATIONS
c.
The
METHODS
EQUIPMENT DETAILS
D.
E.
INPUT -OUTPUT
F.
ADDITIONAL REMARKS
Input data are prepared the same as for program 713-F3-RO 066, "CSTR-Concrete
Strength Investigation and Design of Hydraulic Structures (X0066)." Differences between the two programs lie only in the stress block depth and other
parameters. Call WES, (601) 634-2300 or FTS 542-2300 for more information.
WES
FORM
'
JUt...
ao
2205
O-17
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
GLOSSARY
TERMS
Active earth pressure: Minimum horizontal pressure condition which develops
when a wall rotates about its base and away from the backfill 0.001 to
0.003 radian (see paragraphs 3-4a and 3-5, and Figure 3-1).
At-rest earth pressure: Lateral pressure condition when no wall movement
occurs (see paragraphs 3-4c, 3-7, 3-10, and Figure 3-1).
Bond breaker: A coating or sheet of a substance that does not adhere to concrete, placed on one monolith in the area where concrete will be placed later,
to maintain separate movement of the two monoliths.
Breaking wave:
Broken wave:
See "waves."
See "waves."
Symbol for cohesion value (see paragraph 3-5 and Figure 3-8).
Coastal flood wall: A flood wall that is resisting the effects of the surge
tide and waves accompanying a storm. See paragraphs 4-1a and 7-1.
Closed-face structure (Chapter 10): A prefabricated facing system for an alternative type of retaining wall, where the facing has no openings. The joints
between precast panels will form a pattern but vegetation cannot grow through
them. See open-face structure.
Counterfort: Like a buttress, except located over the toe instead of over the
heel. The fin is in tension instead of the compression of the buttress.
Diffraction (of waves): The effect of bending of the direction of propagation
(travel) of a wave crest as it passes by the end of a jetty or through an
opening. Thus the wave pattern spreads outward into the sheltered region
within the barriers geometric shadow.
Drained phi value:
Drained soil tests: Tests in which the confining and shear stresses are applied so slowly that pore water pressure does not build up. An increase in
applied stress produces an equal increase in effective stress.
Driving force: A force acting to move the wall, usually caused by earth and
water beyond the end of the heel. See paragraph 3-7.
GLOSSARY-1
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
Driving wedge: A wedge of soil which produces a horizontal force (a driving
force) tending to cause instability of a wall. See paragraph 3-7.
Fetch: The area of water in which waves are generated by a wind having a
fairly constant direction and speed. Sometimes used synonymously with "fetch
length," the horizontal distance over which a wind generates waves.
Frequency of a wave:
See "waves."
Heel: The heel of a wall is the base slab projection pointing toward the net
driving force.
Kern: The portion of the area under the base such that when the resultant
normal force ("N" or "V" in the figures in this manual) is inside the kern,
the entire base is in compression contact with the subgrade. When the resultant normal force is located outside the kern, some portion of the base will be
tending to lift off of the subgrade instead of being in compression contact.
For a rectangular base, the edges of the kern will lie at the one-third points
of the base width, as shown in Figure 4-4.
Nonbreaking wave:
See "waves."
Open-faced structure (Chapter 10): A prefabricated facing system for an alternative type of retaining wall, where the precast facing units have openings
between or through them. Vegetation, usually evergreen, is then planted so as
to grow through the openings and present a more natural appearance of the
walls exposed face.
Phi:
Passive earth pressure: Pressure condition that develops when a wall is moved
toward backfill, causing horizontal stresses to increase and shear stresses to
reverse direction (see paragraphs 3-4b and 3-5).
Protected side (of a flood wall or seawall):
tected from flooding.
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
than that part still advancing in deeper water, causing the wave crest to bend
toward alignment with the underwater contours.
Resisting force:
graph 3-8.
See para-
Resisting wedge: A wedge of soil which produces a lateral reaction (a resisting force) which tends to resist instability of a wall. See paragraph 3-8.
S test (of soil): Also known as a consolidated drained or CD test. The confining stresses are applied so slowly that the neutral stress does not change.
The soil consolidates with no change in neutral stress.
Seawall: See paragraph 1-4a, especially the comparison with a coastal flood
wall. A seawall is usually a gravity structure for the purpose of protecting
the area behind it from the action of tide and waves in front of it, sometimes
with a face shaped to dissipate wave energy.
Shoaling: Point at which the water depth gets more shallow as the wave crest
approaches the shoreline or a wall.
Stem:
Surge stillwater level: A rise above normal water level on the open coast due
to the action of wind stress on the water surface. Surges resulting from hurricanes also include the rise in level due to atmospheric pressure reduction.
Structural wedge: The structural wedge consists of the structure itself with
any soil and water contained within the boundaries of the structure or over the
base.
Toe: The toe of a wall is the portion of the base slab pointing toward the net
resisting force.
Train, wave:
See "waves."
Undrained soil tests: Tests where the pore water pressure is not allowed to
dissipate and the water carries all of the applied stresses.
Unprotected side of a flood wall or seawall:
storm tide and waves, or rising water.
Wall friction: The angle of friction between a soil mass tending to move
parallel along the interface between the soil mass and a wall. See paragraph 3-14.
Water stop: A strip of material, cast into each of two adjacent concrete
monoliths and spanning the space between them, for the purpose of preventing
the flow of water through the space. Usually made of elastomeric material for
GLOSSARY-3
EM 1110-2-2502
29 Sep 89
civil works structures, but also made of sheet metal.
Figure 7-9.
Wave parameter definitions (see paragraph 3-24) are best obtained from Chapter 7 of the Shore Protection Manual (U. S. Army Engineer Waterways Experiment
Station 1984).* Abbreviated definitions are shown below.
Breaking wave: While there are several types of breaking waves, the type
associated with the high-impulse effects used in this manual is the
plunging breaker, where the wave crest becomes more and more steep, until
the crest curls forward and falls over a pocket of trapped air. This is
characterized by a very large dynamic impulse of short (0.2 second, approximately) duration and a rise in hydrostatic pressure from still water
(no wave) up to the crest one-half of the wave height above still water.
See paragraph 3-24d.
Broken wave: A somewhat confused mass of water surging forward after the
wave has broken some distance away from the wall. See paragraph 3-24e.
Nonbreaking wave: A wave impacting on a wall under conditions where there
is no breaking tendency but the mass of water is stopped from forward motion by the wall and imparts its energy to the vertical face. See paragraph 3-24c.
Wave height: The vertical distance from the crest of a wave to the adjacent trough (lowest elevation). A continuously changing value in a
typical train of waves, frequently assumed to have a Gaussian distribution. See paragraph 3-24b for the assumed values as fractions of the
significant wave height (an average of the highest one-third of all of the
waves in the wave train is assumed for design of the structure).
Wave length: The horizontal distance from one wave crest to the next
crest in the group (train) of waves. A continuously changing value in a
typical train of waves, frequently assumed to have a Gaussian
distribution.
Wave steepness:
Wave train:
fetch.
A group of waves coming from the same direction over the same
Wave frequency: The number of wave crests passing a given point in one
second, the reciprocal of the wave period.
Wave period: The time in seconds required for a wave crest to travel a
distance of one wave length, the reciprocal of the frequency.
______________________________________________________________________________
* References cited in this appendix may be found in Appendix A, "References."
GLOSSARY-4